Mercurial > emacs
annotate lispintro/texinfo.tex @ 47341:bbfc60a6c247
(isearch-cmds): Add docstring.
(isearch-mouse-2): Lookup binding in the proper buffer.
Use call-interactively and remove the now useless `arg'.
(isearch-search-fun-function): New var.
(isearch-search-fun): New fun.
(isearch-search, isearch-lazy-highlight-search): Use it.
author | Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca> |
---|---|
date | Mon, 09 Sep 2002 21:05:22 +0000 |
parents | f267224443ae |
children | 23a1cea22d13 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
41418 | 1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. |
2 % | |
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. | |
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi | |
5 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6 \def\texinfoversion{2002-06-07.15} |
41418 | 7 % |
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99, | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
9 % 2000, 01, 02 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
41418 | 10 % |
11 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or | |
12 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as | |
13 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at | |
14 % your option) any later version. | |
15 % | |
16 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be | |
17 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty | |
18 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU | |
19 % General Public License for more details. | |
20 % | |
21 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
22 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write | |
23 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, | |
24 % Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. | |
25 % | |
26 % In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program. | |
27 % You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve | |
28 % what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! | |
29 % | |
30 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug | |
31 % reports; you can get the latest version from: | |
32 % ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo.tex | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
33 % (and all GNU mirrors, see http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html) |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
34 % ftp://texinfo.org/texinfo/texinfo.tex |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
35 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
36 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org), |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
37 % and /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
38 % |
41418 | 39 % The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out |
40 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
41 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
42 % Texinfo has a small home page at http://texinfo.org/ and also |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
43 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. |
41418 | 44 % |
45 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a | |
46 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the | |
47 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. | |
48 % | |
49 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the | |
50 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple | |
51 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: | |
52 % tex foo.texi | |
53 % texindex foo.?? | |
54 % tex foo.texi | |
55 % tex foo.texi | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
56 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
57 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. |
41418 | 58 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more |
59 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. | |
60 % | |
61 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages. You can get | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
62 % the existing language-specific files from the full Texinfo distribution. |
41418 | 63 |
64 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} | |
65 | |
66 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number | |
67 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because | |
68 % they might have appeared in the input file name. | |
69 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% | |
70 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} | |
71 | |
72 % Save some parts of plain tex whose names we will redefine. | |
73 \let\ptexb=\b | |
74 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet | |
75 \let\ptexc=\c | |
76 \let\ptexcomma=\, | |
77 \let\ptexdot=\. | |
78 \let\ptexdots=\dots | |
79 \let\ptexend=\end | |
80 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv | |
81 \let\ptexexclam=\! | |
82 \let\ptexi=\i | |
83 \let\ptexlbrace=\{ | |
84 \let\ptexrbrace=\} | |
85 \let\ptexstar=\* | |
86 \let\ptext=\t | |
87 | |
88 % We never want plain's outer \+ definition in Texinfo. | |
89 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. | |
90 \let\+ = \relax | |
91 | |
92 \message{Basics,} | |
93 \chardef\other=12 | |
94 | |
95 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it | |
96 % starts a new line in the output. | |
97 \newlinechar = `^^J | |
98 | |
99 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. | |
100 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi | |
101 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi | |
102 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi | |
103 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi | |
104 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi | |
105 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi | |
106 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi | |
107 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi | |
108 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi | |
109 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi | |
110 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi | |
111 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi | |
112 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi | |
113 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi | |
114 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi | |
115 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi | |
116 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi | |
117 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi | |
118 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi | |
119 % | |
120 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi | |
121 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi | |
122 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi | |
123 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi | |
124 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi | |
125 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi | |
126 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi | |
127 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi | |
128 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi | |
129 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi | |
130 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi | |
131 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi | |
132 % | |
133 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi | |
134 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi | |
135 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi | |
136 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi | |
137 \ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi | |
138 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi | |
139 \ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi | |
140 | |
141 % Ignore a token. | |
142 % | |
143 \def\gobble#1{} | |
144 | |
145 \hyphenation{ap-pen-dix} | |
146 \hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers} | |
147 \hyphenation{eshell} | |
148 \hyphenation{white-space} | |
149 | |
150 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. | |
151 \newdimen \bindingoffset | |
152 \newdimen \normaloffset | |
153 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight | |
154 | |
155 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file | |
156 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, | |
157 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. | |
158 % | |
159 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% | |
160 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined | |
161 \def\loggingall{\tracingcommands2 \tracingstats2 | |
162 \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1 | |
163 \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1 | |
164 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen | |
165 }% | |
166 \else | |
167 \def\loggingall{\tracingcommands3 \tracingstats2 | |
168 \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1 | |
169 \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1 | |
170 \tracingscantokens1 \tracingassigns1 \tracingifs1 | |
171 \tracinggroups1 \tracingnesting2 | |
172 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen | |
173 }% | |
174 \fi | |
175 | |
176 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing | |
177 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. | |
178 % | |
179 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount | |
180 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} | |
181 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount | |
182 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} | |
183 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount | |
184 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} | |
185 | |
186 % For @cropmarks command. | |
187 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. | |
188 % | |
189 \newif\ifcropmarks | |
190 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue | |
191 % | |
192 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. | |
193 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 | |
194 % | |
195 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines | |
196 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc | |
197 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt | |
198 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in | |
199 | |
200 % Main output routine. | |
201 \chardef\PAGE = 255 | |
202 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} | |
203 | |
204 \newbox\headlinebox | |
205 \newbox\footlinebox | |
206 | |
207 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents | |
208 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. | |
209 \def\onepageout#1{% | |
210 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi | |
211 % | |
212 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset | |
213 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi | |
214 % | |
215 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in | |
216 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). | |
217 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% | |
218 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% | |
219 % | |
220 {% | |
221 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to | |
222 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends | |
223 % before the \shipout runs. | |
224 % | |
225 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. | |
226 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. | |
227 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if | |
228 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. | |
229 \shipout\vbox{% | |
230 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. | |
231 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno} \fi | |
232 % | |
233 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup | |
234 \hsize = \outerhsize | |
235 \vskip-\topandbottommargin | |
236 \vtop to0pt{% | |
237 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% | |
238 \nointerlineskip | |
239 \line{% | |
240 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% | |
241 \hfill | |
242 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% | |
243 }% | |
244 \vss}% | |
245 \vskip\topandbottommargin | |
246 \line\bgroup | |
247 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. | |
248 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi | |
249 \vbox\bgroup | |
250 \fi | |
251 % | |
252 \unvbox\headlinebox | |
253 \pagebody{#1}% | |
254 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt | |
255 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. | |
256 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) | |
257 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. | |
258 \vskip 2\baselineskip | |
259 \unvbox\footlinebox | |
260 \fi | |
261 % | |
262 \ifcropmarks | |
263 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup | |
264 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup | |
265 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill | |
266 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick | |
267 \vbox to0pt{\vss | |
268 \line{% | |
269 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% | |
270 \hfill | |
271 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% | |
272 }% | |
273 \nointerlineskip | |
274 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% | |
275 }% | |
276 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause | |
277 \fi | |
278 }% end of \shipout\vbox | |
279 }% end of group with \turnoffactive | |
280 \advancepageno | |
281 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi | |
282 } | |
283 | |
284 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen | |
285 | |
286 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} | |
287 {\catcode`\@ =11 | |
288 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi | |
289 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) | |
290 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present | |
291 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi | |
292 \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1 | |
293 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi | |
294 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} | |
295 } | |
296 | |
297 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are | |
298 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize | |
299 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) | |
300 % | |
301 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} | |
302 \def\nstop{\vbox | |
303 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} | |
304 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} | |
305 \def\nsbot{\vbox | |
306 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} | |
307 | |
308 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of | |
309 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a | |
310 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. | |
311 % | |
312 \def\parsearg#1{% | |
313 \let\next = #1% | |
314 \begingroup | |
315 \obeylines | |
316 \futurelet\temp\parseargx | |
317 } | |
318 | |
319 % If the next token is an obeyed space (from an @example environment or | |
320 % the like), remove it and recurse. Otherwise, we're done. | |
321 \def\parseargx{% | |
322 % \obeyedspace is defined far below, after the definition of \sepspaces. | |
323 \ifx\obeyedspace\temp | |
324 \expandafter\parseargdiscardspace | |
325 \else | |
326 \expandafter\parseargline | |
327 \fi | |
328 } | |
329 | |
330 % Remove a single space (as the delimiter token to the macro call). | |
331 {\obeyspaces % | |
332 \gdef\parseargdiscardspace {\futurelet\temp\parseargx}} | |
333 | |
334 {\obeylines % | |
335 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% | |
336 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. | |
337 % | |
338 % First remove any @c comment, then any @comment. | |
339 % Result of each macro is put in \toks0. | |
340 \argremovec #1\c\relax % | |
341 \expandafter\argremovecomment \the\toks0 \comment\relax % | |
342 % | |
343 % Call the caller's macro, saved as \next in \parsearg. | |
344 \expandafter\next\expandafter{\the\toks0}% | |
345 }% | |
346 } | |
347 | |
348 % Since all \c{,omment} does is throw away the argument, we can let TeX | |
349 % do that for us. The \relax here is matched by the \relax in the call | |
350 % in \parseargline; it could be more or less anything, its purpose is | |
351 % just to delimit the argument to the \c. | |
352 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}} | |
353 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}} | |
354 | |
355 % \argremovec{,omment} might leave us with trailing spaces, though; e.g., | |
356 % @end itemize @c foo | |
357 % will have two active spaces as part of the argument with the | |
358 % `itemize'. Here we remove all active spaces from #1, and assign the | |
359 % result to \toks0. | |
360 % | |
361 % This loses if there are any *other* active characters besides spaces | |
362 % in the argument -- _ ^ +, for example -- since they get expanded. | |
363 % Fortunately, Texinfo does not define any such commands. (If it ever | |
364 % does, the catcode of the characters in questionwill have to be changed | |
365 % here.) But this means we cannot call \removeactivespaces as part of | |
366 % \argremovec{,omment}, since @c uses \parsearg, and thus the argument | |
367 % that \parsearg gets might well have any character at all in it. | |
368 % | |
369 \def\removeactivespaces#1{% | |
370 \begingroup | |
371 \ignoreactivespaces | |
372 \edef\temp{#1}% | |
373 \global\toks0 = \expandafter{\temp}% | |
374 \endgroup | |
375 } | |
376 | |
377 % Change the active space to expand to nothing. | |
378 % | |
379 \begingroup | |
380 \obeyspaces | |
381 \gdef\ignoreactivespaces{\obeyspaces\let =\empty} | |
382 \endgroup | |
383 | |
384 | |
385 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} | |
386 | |
387 %% These are used to keep @begin/@end levels from running away | |
388 %% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup) | |
389 \newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi} | |
390 \def\ENVcheck{% | |
391 \ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue} | |
392 \endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage | |
393 | |
394 % @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now. | |
395 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} | |
396 | |
397 \outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx} | |
398 | |
399 \def\beginxxx #1{% | |
400 \expandafter\ifx\csname #1\endcsname\relax | |
401 {\errhelp=\EMsimple \errmessage{Undefined command @begin #1}}\else | |
402 \csname #1\endcsname\fi} | |
403 | |
404 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. | |
405 % | |
406 \def\end{\parsearg\endxxx} | |
407 \def\endxxx #1{% | |
408 \removeactivespaces{#1}% | |
409 \edef\endthing{\the\toks0}% | |
410 % | |
411 \expandafter\ifx\csname E\endthing\endcsname\relax | |
412 \expandafter\ifx\csname \endthing\endcsname\relax | |
413 % There's no \foo, i.e., no ``environment'' foo. | |
414 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
415 \errmessage{Undefined command `@end \endthing'}% | |
416 \else | |
417 \unmatchedenderror\endthing | |
418 \fi | |
419 \else | |
420 % Everything's ok; the right environment has been started. | |
421 \csname E\endthing\endcsname | |
422 \fi | |
423 } | |
424 | |
425 % There is an environment #1, but it hasn't been started. Give an error. | |
426 % | |
427 \def\unmatchedenderror#1{% | |
428 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
429 \errmessage{This `@end #1' doesn't have a matching `@#1'}% | |
430 } | |
431 | |
432 % Define the control sequence \E#1 to give an unmatched @end error. | |
433 % | |
434 \def\defineunmatchedend#1{% | |
435 \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\unmatchedenderror{#1}}% | |
436 } | |
437 | |
438 | |
439 % Single-spacing is done by various environments (specifically, in | |
440 % \nonfillstart and \quotations). | |
441 \newskip\singlespaceskip \singlespaceskip = 12.5pt | |
442 \def\singlespace{% | |
443 % Why was this kern here? It messes up equalizing space above and below | |
444 % environments. --karl, 6may93 | |
445 %{\advance \baselineskip by -\singlespaceskip | |
446 %\kern \baselineskip}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
447 \setleading\singlespaceskip |
41418 | 448 } |
449 | |
450 %% Simple single-character @ commands | |
451 | |
452 % @@ prints an @ | |
453 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). | |
454 \def\@{{\tt\char64}} | |
455 | |
456 % This is turned off because it was never documented | |
457 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. | |
458 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and ' | |
459 %% but suppressing ligatures. | |
460 %\def\`{{`}} | |
461 %\def\'{{'}} | |
462 | |
463 % Used to generate quoted braces. | |
464 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} | |
465 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} | |
466 \let\{=\mylbrace | |
467 \let\}=\myrbrace | |
468 \begingroup | |
469 % Definitions to produce actual \{ & \} command in an index. | |
470 \catcode`\{ = 12 \catcode`\} = 12 | |
471 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 | |
472 \catcode`\@ = 0 \catcode`\\ = 12 | |
473 @gdef@lbracecmd[\{]% | |
474 @gdef@rbracecmd[\}]% | |
475 @endgroup | |
476 | |
477 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent | |
478 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @v @H. | |
479 \let\, = \c | |
480 \let\dotaccent = \. | |
481 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} | |
482 \let\tieaccent = \t | |
483 \let\ubaraccent = \b | |
484 \let\udotaccent = \d | |
485 | |
486 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown | |
487 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (and lowercase versions) @ss. | |
488 \def\questiondown{?`} | |
489 \def\exclamdown{!`} | |
490 | |
491 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. | |
492 \def\imacro{i} | |
493 \def\jmacro{j} | |
494 \def\dotless#1{% | |
495 \def\temp{#1}% | |
496 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi | |
497 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j | |
498 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% | |
499 \fi\fi | |
500 } | |
501 | |
502 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space | |
503 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space | |
504 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and | |
505 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the | |
506 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. | |
507 {\catcode`@ = 11 | |
508 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble | |
509 % if the definition is written into an index file. | |
510 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M | |
511 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } | |
512 } | |
513 | |
514 % @: forces normal size whitespace following. | |
515 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } | |
516 | |
517 % @* forces a line break. | |
518 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} | |
519 | |
520 % @. is an end-of-sentence period. | |
521 \def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 } | |
522 | |
523 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. | |
524 \def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } | |
525 | |
526 % @? is an end-of-sentence query. | |
527 \def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } | |
528 | |
529 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the | |
530 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would | |
531 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. | |
532 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} | |
533 | |
534 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing | |
535 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box | |
536 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for | |
537 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is | |
538 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, | |
539 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and | |
540 % the text is small, which looks bad. | |
541 % | |
542 \def\group{\begingroup | |
543 \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else | |
544 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp | |
545 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% | |
546 \fi | |
547 % | |
548 % The \vtop we start below produces a box with normal height and large | |
549 % depth; thus, TeX puts \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the | |
550 % next line of text is done) \lineskip glue after it. (See p.82 of | |
551 % the TeXbook.) Thus, space below is not quite equal to space | |
552 % above. But it's pretty close. | |
553 \def\Egroup{% | |
554 \egroup % End the \vtop. | |
555 \endgroup % End the \group. | |
556 }% | |
557 % | |
558 \vtop\bgroup | |
559 % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in | |
560 % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it. | |
561 % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group | |
562 % and the first line afterwards is too small. But we can't put the | |
563 % strut in \Egroup, since there it would be on a line by itself. | |
564 % Hence this just inserts a strut at the beginning of each line. | |
565 \everypar = {\strut}% | |
566 % | |
567 % Since we have a strut on every line, we don't need any of TeX's | |
568 % normal interline spacing. | |
569 \offinterlineskip | |
570 % | |
571 % OK, but now we have to do something about blank | |
572 % lines in the input in @example-like environments, which normally | |
573 % just turn into \lisppar, which will insert no space now that we've | |
574 % turned off the interline space. Simplest is to make them be an | |
575 % empty paragraph. | |
576 \ifx\par\lisppar | |
577 \edef\par{\leavevmode \par}% | |
578 % | |
579 % Reset ^^M's definition to new definition of \par. | |
580 \obeylines | |
581 \fi | |
582 % | |
583 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as | |
584 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an | |
585 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after | |
586 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group | |
587 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo | |
588 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. | |
589 \comment | |
590 } | |
591 % | |
592 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help | |
593 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. | |
594 % | |
595 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% | |
596 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% | |
597 where each line of input produces a line of output.} | |
598 | |
599 % @need space-in-mils | |
600 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. | |
601 | |
602 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in | |
603 | |
604 \def\need{\parsearg\needx} | |
605 | |
606 % Old definition--didn't work. | |
607 %\def\needx #1{\par % | |
608 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally | |
609 %% if the depth of the box does not fit. | |
610 %{\baselineskip=0pt% | |
611 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak | |
612 %\prevdepth=-1000pt | |
613 %}} | |
614 | |
615 \def\needx#1{% | |
616 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a | |
617 % paragraph. | |
618 \par | |
619 % | |
620 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. | |
621 \dimen0 = #1\mil | |
622 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox | |
623 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox | |
624 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 | |
625 % | |
626 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the | |
627 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. | |
628 % And a page break here is fine. | |
629 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% | |
630 % | |
631 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the | |
632 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the | |
633 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider | |
634 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the | |
635 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. | |
636 % | |
637 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the | |
638 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in | |
639 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which | |
640 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing | |
641 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an | |
642 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real | |
643 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. | |
644 \penalty9999 | |
645 % | |
646 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. | |
647 \kern -#1\mil | |
648 % | |
649 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. | |
650 \nobreak | |
651 \fi | |
652 } | |
653 | |
654 % @br forces paragraph break | |
655 | |
656 \let\br = \par | |
657 | |
658 % @dots{} output an ellipsis using the current font. | |
659 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter | |
660 % font as three actual period characters. | |
661 % | |
662 \def\dots{% | |
663 \leavevmode | |
664 \hbox to 1.5em{% | |
665 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil | |
666 .\hss.\hss.% | |
667 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil | |
668 }% | |
669 } | |
670 | |
671 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. | |
672 % | |
673 \def\enddots{% | |
674 \leavevmode | |
675 \hbox to 2em{% | |
676 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil | |
677 .\hss.\hss.\hss.% | |
678 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil | |
679 }% | |
680 \spacefactor=3000 | |
681 } | |
682 | |
683 | |
684 % @page forces the start of a new page | |
685 % | |
686 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} | |
687 | |
688 % @exdent text.... | |
689 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin | |
690 | |
691 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. | |
692 % That's how much \exdent should take out. | |
693 \newskip\exdentamount | |
694 | |
695 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. | |
696 \def\exdent{\parsearg\exdentyyy} | |
697 \def\exdentyyy #1{{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}} | |
698 | |
699 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. | |
700 \def\nofillexdent{\parsearg\nofillexdentyyy} | |
701 \def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount | |
702 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} | |
703 | |
704 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current | |
705 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion | |
706 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. | |
707 % | |
708 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm | |
709 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} | |
710 % | |
711 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% | |
712 \nobreak | |
713 \kern-\strutdepth | |
714 \vtop to \strutdepth{% | |
715 \baselineskip=\strutdepth | |
716 \vss | |
717 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to | |
718 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. | |
719 \ifx#1l% | |
720 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% | |
721 \else | |
722 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% | |
723 \fi | |
724 \null | |
725 }% | |
726 }} | |
727 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} | |
728 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} | |
729 % | |
730 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} | |
731 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; | |
732 % else use TEXT for both). | |
733 % | |
734 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} | |
735 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. | |
736 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
737 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
738 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts | |
739 \def\righttext{#2}% | |
740 \else | |
741 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text | |
742 \def\righttext{#1}% | |
743 \fi | |
744 % | |
745 \ifodd\pageno | |
746 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin | |
747 \else | |
748 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% | |
749 \fi | |
750 \temp | |
751 } | |
752 | |
753 % @include file insert text of that file as input. | |
754 % Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). | |
755 \def\include{\begingroup | |
756 \catcode`\\=12 | |
757 \catcode`~=12 | |
758 \catcode`^=12 | |
759 \catcode`_=12 | |
760 \catcode`|=12 | |
761 \catcode`<=12 | |
762 \catcode`>=12 | |
763 \catcode`+=12 | |
764 \parsearg\includezzz} | |
765 % Restore active chars for included file. | |
766 \def\includezzz#1{\endgroup\begingroup | |
767 % Read the included file in a group so nested @include's work. | |
768 \def\thisfile{#1}% | |
769 \input\thisfile | |
770 \endgroup} | |
771 | |
772 \def\thisfile{} | |
773 | |
774 % @center line outputs that line, centered | |
775 | |
776 \def\center{\parsearg\centerzzz} | |
777 \def\centerzzz #1{{\advance\hsize by -\leftskip | |
778 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip | |
779 \centerline{#1}}} | |
780 | |
781 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space | |
782 | |
783 \def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx} | |
784 \def\spxxx #1{\vskip #1\baselineskip} | |
785 | |
786 % @comment ...line which is ignored... | |
787 % @c is the same as @comment | |
788 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment | |
789 | |
790 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% | |
791 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% | |
792 \commentxxx} | |
793 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} | |
794 | |
795 \let\c=\comment | |
796 | |
797 % @paragraphindent NCHARS | |
798 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. | |
799 % We cannot implement @paragraphindent asis, though. | |
800 % | |
801 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords | |
802 \def\noneword{none} | |
803 % | |
804 \def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent} | |
805 \def\doparagraphindent#1{% | |
806 \def\temp{#1}% | |
807 \ifx\temp\asisword | |
808 \else | |
809 \ifx\temp\noneword | |
810 \defaultparindent = 0pt | |
811 \else | |
812 \defaultparindent = #1em | |
813 \fi | |
814 \fi | |
815 \parindent = \defaultparindent | |
816 } | |
817 | |
818 % @exampleindent NCHARS | |
819 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. | |
820 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but | |
821 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. | |
822 \def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent} | |
823 \def\doexampleindent#1{% | |
824 \def\temp{#1}% | |
825 \ifx\temp\asisword | |
826 \else | |
827 \ifx\temp\noneword | |
828 \lispnarrowing = 0pt | |
829 \else | |
830 \lispnarrowing = #1em | |
831 \fi | |
832 \fi | |
833 } | |
834 | |
835 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. | |
836 % | |
837 \def\asis#1{#1} | |
838 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
839 % @math outputs its argument in math mode. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
840 % We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because we need |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
841 % to set catcodes according to plain TeX first, to allow for subscripts, |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
842 % superscripts, special math chars, etc. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
843 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
844 % @math does not do math typesetting in section titles, index |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
845 % entries, and other such contexts where the catcodes are set before |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
846 % @math gets a chance to work. This could perhaps be fixed, but for now |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
847 % at least we can have real math in the main text, where it's needed most. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
848 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
849 \let\implicitmath = $%$ font-lock fix |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
850 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
851 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
852 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
853 % _ within @math be active (mathcode "8000), and distinguish by seeing |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
854 % if the current family is \slfam, which is what @var uses. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
855 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
856 {\catcode95 = \active % 95 = _ |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
857 \gdef\mathunderscore{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
858 \catcode95=\active |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
859 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
860 }} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
861 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
862 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
863 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
864 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
865 % otherwise define @\. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
866 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
867 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
868 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
869 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
870 \def\math{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
871 \tex |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
872 \mathcode`\_="8000 \mathunderscore |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
873 \let\\ = \mathbackslash |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
874 \implicitmath\finishmath} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
875 \def\finishmath#1{#1\implicitmath\Etex} |
41418 | 876 |
877 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. | |
878 \def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath} | |
879 \def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath} | |
880 | |
881 % @refill is a no-op. | |
882 \let\refill=\relax | |
883 | |
884 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to | |
885 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. | |
886 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). | |
887 % | |
888 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. | |
889 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse | |
890 | |
891 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. | |
892 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. | |
893 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. | |
894 \def\setfilename{% | |
895 \iflinks | |
896 \readauxfile | |
897 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. | |
898 \openindices | |
899 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. | |
900 \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. | |
901 % | |
902 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. | |
903 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. | |
904 % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input. | |
905 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf | |
906 \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi | |
907 \closein1 | |
908 \temp | |
909 % | |
910 \comment % Ignore the actual filename. | |
911 } | |
912 | |
913 % Called from \setfilename. | |
914 % | |
915 \def\openindices{% | |
916 \newindex{cp}% | |
917 \newcodeindex{fn}% | |
918 \newcodeindex{vr}% | |
919 \newcodeindex{tp}% | |
920 \newcodeindex{ky}% | |
921 \newcodeindex{pg}% | |
922 } | |
923 | |
924 % @bye. | |
925 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} | |
926 | |
927 | |
928 \message{pdf,} | |
929 % adobe `portable' document format | |
930 \newcount\tempnum | |
931 \newcount\lnkcount | |
932 \newtoks\filename | |
933 \newcount\filenamelength | |
934 \newcount\pgn | |
935 \newtoks\toksA | |
936 \newtoks\toksB | |
937 \newtoks\toksC | |
938 \newtoks\toksD | |
939 \newbox\boxA | |
940 \newcount\countA | |
941 \newif\ifpdf | |
942 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest | |
943 | |
944 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined | |
945 \pdffalse | |
946 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble | |
947 \let\pdfurl = \gobble | |
948 \let\endlink = \relax | |
949 \let\linkcolor = \relax | |
950 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax | |
951 \else | |
952 \pdftrue | |
953 \pdfoutput = 1 | |
954 \input pdfcolor | |
955 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% | |
956 \def\imagewidth{#2}% | |
957 \def\imageheight{#3}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
958 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
959 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) |
41418 | 960 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
961 \immediate\pdfimage |
41418 | 962 \else |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
963 \immediate\pdfximage |
41418 | 964 \fi |
965 \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi | |
966 \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi | |
967 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 | |
968 #1.pdf% | |
969 \else | |
970 {#1.pdf}% | |
971 \fi | |
972 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else | |
973 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage | |
974 \fi} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
975 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{\normalturnoffactive \pdfdest name{#1} xyz}} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
976 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} |
41418 | 977 \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? |
978 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} | |
979 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines | |
980 % come from Petr Olsak | |
981 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% | |
982 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} | |
983 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax | |
984 \advance\tempnum by1 | |
985 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} | |
986 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{{% | |
987 \openin 1 \jobname.toc | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
988 \ifeof 1\else\begingroup |
41418 | 989 \closein 1 |
990 \indexnofonts | |
991 \def\tt{} | |
992 \let\_ = \normalunderscore | |
993 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks | |
994 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace | |
995 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace | |
996 % | |
997 \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
998 \let\appendixentry = \chapentry |
41418 | 999 \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{} |
1000 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{chap##2}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1001 \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2##3{\advancenumber{chap##2}} |
41418 | 1002 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{\advancenumber{sec##2.##3}} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1003 \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{sec##2.##3}} |
41418 | 1004 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{\advancenumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1005 \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{\advancenumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}} |
41418 | 1006 \input \jobname.toc |
1007 \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{% | |
1008 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##3}}count-\expnumber{chap##2}{##1}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1009 \let\appendixentry = \chapentry |
41418 | 1010 \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{% |
1011 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}} | |
1012 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{% | |
1013 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##4}}count-\expnumber{sec##2.##3}{##1}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1014 \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2##3{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1015 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##3}}{##1}} |
41418 | 1016 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{% |
1017 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##5}}count-\expnumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}{##1}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1018 \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1019 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##4}}{##1}} |
41418 | 1020 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{% |
1021 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##6}}{##1}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1022 \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1023 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##5}}{##1}} |
41418 | 1024 \input \jobname.toc |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1025 \endgroup\fi |
41418 | 1026 }} |
1027 \def\makelinks #1,{% | |
1028 \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% | |
1029 \ifx\params\E | |
1030 \let\nextmakelinks=\relax | |
1031 \else | |
1032 \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks | |
1033 \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi | |
1034 \picknum{#1}% | |
1035 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} | |
1036 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% | |
1037 \linkcolor #1% | |
1038 \advance\lnkcount by 1% | |
1039 \endlink | |
1040 \fi | |
1041 \nextmakelinks | |
1042 } | |
1043 \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} | |
1044 \def\pn#1{% | |
1045 \def\p{#1}% | |
1046 \ifx\p\lbrace | |
1047 \let\nextpn=\ppn | |
1048 \else | |
1049 \let\nextpn=\ppnn | |
1050 \def\first{#1} | |
1051 \fi | |
1052 \nextpn | |
1053 } | |
1054 \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} | |
1055 \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} | |
1056 \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} | |
1057 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} | |
1058 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% | |
1059 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax | |
1060 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces | |
1061 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% | |
1062 \advance\filenamelength by 1 | |
1063 \fi | |
1064 \fi | |
1065 \nextsp} | |
1066 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} | |
1067 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 | |
1068 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink | |
1069 \else | |
1070 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink | |
1071 \fi | |
1072 \def\pdfurl#1{% | |
1073 \begingroup | |
1074 \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% | |
1075 \let\value=\expandablevalue | |
1076 \leavevmode\Red | |
1077 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% | |
1078 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% | |
1079 % #1 | |
1080 \endgroup} | |
1081 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} | |
1082 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} | |
1083 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} | |
1084 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} | |
1085 \def\maketoks{% | |
1086 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS| | |
1087 \ifx\first0\adn0 | |
1088 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 | |
1089 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 | |
1090 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 | |
1091 \else | |
1092 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi | |
1093 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else | |
1094 \let\next=\maketoks | |
1095 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} | |
1096 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi | |
1097 \fi | |
1098 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi | |
1099 \next} | |
1100 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% | |
1101 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} | |
1102 \def\pdflink#1{% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1103 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} |
41418 | 1104 \linkcolor #1\endlink} |
1105 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} | |
1106 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput | |
1107 | |
1108 | |
1109 \message{fonts,} | |
1110 % Font-change commands. | |
1111 | |
1112 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. | |
1113 % So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc. | |
1114 \newfam\sffam | |
1115 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf} | |
1116 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. | |
1117 | |
1118 % We don't need math for this one. | |
1119 \def\ttsl{\tenttsl} | |
1120 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1121 % Default leading. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1122 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1123 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1124 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1125 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1126 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1127 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1128 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1129 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1130 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1131 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1132 \def\setleading#1{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1133 \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1134 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1135 \normalbaselines |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1136 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1137 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1138 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1139 }% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1140 } |
41418 | 1141 |
1142 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the | |
1143 % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). | |
1144 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor | |
1145 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} | |
1146 | |
1147 % Use cm as the default font prefix. | |
1148 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix | |
1149 % before you read in texinfo.tex. | |
1150 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined | |
1151 \def\fontprefix{cm} | |
1152 \fi | |
1153 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. | |
1154 \def\rmshape{r} | |
1155 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold | |
1156 \def\bfshape{b} | |
1157 \def\bxshape{bx} | |
1158 \def\ttshape{tt} | |
1159 \def\ttbshape{tt} | |
1160 \def\ttslshape{sltt} | |
1161 \def\itshape{ti} | |
1162 \def\itbshape{bxti} | |
1163 \def\slshape{sl} | |
1164 \def\slbshape{bxsl} | |
1165 \def\sfshape{ss} | |
1166 \def\sfbshape{ss} | |
1167 \def\scshape{csc} | |
1168 \def\scbshape{csc} | |
1169 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1170 \newcount\mainmagstep |
41418 | 1171 \ifx\bigger\relax |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1172 % not really supported. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1173 \let\mainmagstep=\magstep1 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1174 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1175 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000} |
41418 | 1176 \else |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1177 % \mainmagstep=\magstephalf |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1178 \mainmagstep=\magstep1 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1179 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1180 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
41418 | 1181 \fi |
1182 % Instead of cmb10, you many want to use cmbx10. | |
1183 % cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10 | |
1184 % looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10. | |
1185 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1186 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1187 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1188 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1189 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1190 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} | |
1191 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1192 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1193 | |
1194 % A few fonts for @defun, etc. | |
1195 \setfont\defbf\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} %was 1314 | |
1196 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} | |
1197 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf} | |
1198 | |
1199 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). | |
1200 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} | |
1201 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} | |
1202 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} | |
1203 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} | |
1204 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} | |
1205 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} | |
1206 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} | |
1207 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} | |
1208 \font\smalli=cmmi9 | |
1209 \font\smallsy=cmsy9 | |
1210 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1211 % Fonts for small examples (8pt). |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1212 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1213 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1214 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1215 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1216 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1217 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1218 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1219 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1220 \font\smalleri=cmmi8 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1221 \font\smallersy=cmsy8 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1222 |
41418 | 1223 % Fonts for title page: |
1224 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} | |
1225 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} | |
1226 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} | |
1227 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} | |
1228 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} | |
1229 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} | |
1230 \let\titlebf=\titlerm | |
1231 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} | |
1232 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 | |
1233 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 | |
1234 \def\authorrm{\secrm} | |
1235 | |
1236 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). | |
1237 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} | |
1238 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} | |
1239 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} | |
1240 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} | |
1241 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} | |
1242 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} | |
1243 \let\chapbf=\chaprm | |
1244 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} | |
1245 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 | |
1246 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 | |
1247 | |
1248 % Section fonts (14.4pt). | |
1249 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} | |
1250 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} | |
1251 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} | |
1252 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} | |
1253 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} | |
1254 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} | |
1255 \let\secbf\secrm | |
1256 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} | |
1257 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 | |
1258 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 | |
1259 | |
1260 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). | |
1261 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} | |
1262 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} | |
1263 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} | |
1264 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} | |
1265 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} | |
1266 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} | |
1267 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm | |
1268 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1} | |
1269 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf | |
1270 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 | |
1271 % The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5, | |
1272 % but that is not a standard magnification. | |
1273 | |
1274 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, | |
1275 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1276 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1277 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1278 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). |
41418 | 1279 % |
1280 \def\resetmathfonts{% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1281 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1282 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1283 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf |
41418 | 1284 } |
1285 | |
1286 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead | |
1287 % of just \STYLE. We do this so that font changes will continue to work | |
1288 % in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most | |
1289 % cases, not the current font. Plain TeX does \def\bf{\fam=\bffam | |
1290 % \tenbf}, for example. By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need to | |
1291 % redefine \bf itself. | |
1292 \def\textfonts{% | |
1293 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl | |
1294 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc | |
1295 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy \let\tenttsl=\textttsl | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1296 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} |
41418 | 1297 \def\titlefonts{% |
1298 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl | |
1299 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc | |
1300 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy | |
1301 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl | |
1302 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} | |
1303 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} | |
1304 \def\chapfonts{% | |
1305 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl | |
1306 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc | |
1307 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl | |
1308 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} | |
1309 \def\secfonts{% | |
1310 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl | |
1311 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc | |
1312 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy \let\tenttsl=\secttsl | |
1313 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} | |
1314 \def\subsecfonts{% | |
1315 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl | |
1316 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc | |
1317 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl | |
1318 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} | |
1319 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf? | |
1320 \def\smallfonts{% | |
1321 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl | |
1322 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc | |
1323 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy | |
1324 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1325 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1326 \def\smallerfonts{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1327 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1328 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1329 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1330 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1331 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1332 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallerfonts |
41418 | 1333 |
1334 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. | |
1335 % | |
1336 \textfonts | |
1337 | |
1338 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. | |
1339 \def\angleleft{$\langle$} | |
1340 \def\angleright{$\rangle$} | |
1341 | |
1342 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks | |
1343 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 | |
1344 | |
1345 % Fonts for short table of contents. | |
1346 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} | |
1347 \setfont\shortcontbf\bxshape{12}{1000} | |
1348 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} | |
1349 | |
1350 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans | |
1351 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic | |
1352 | |
1353 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction | |
1354 % unless the following character is such as not to need one. | |
1355 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else\/\fi\fi\fi} | |
1356 \def\smartslanted#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} | |
1357 \def\smartitalic#1{{\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} | |
1358 | |
1359 \let\i=\smartitalic | |
1360 \let\var=\smartslanted | |
1361 \let\dfn=\smartslanted | |
1362 \let\emph=\smartitalic | |
1363 \let\cite=\smartslanted | |
1364 | |
1365 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} | |
1366 \let\strong=\b | |
1367 | |
1368 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at | |
1369 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the | |
1370 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. | |
1371 % | |
1372 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} | |
1373 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } | |
1374 | |
1375 \def\t#1{% | |
1376 {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% | |
1377 \null | |
1378 } | |
1379 \let\ttfont=\t | |
1380 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} | |
1381 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} | |
1382 \font\keysy=cmsy9 | |
1383 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% | |
1384 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% | |
1385 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt | |
1386 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% | |
1387 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% | |
1388 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} | |
1389 % The old definition, with no lozenge: | |
1390 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} | |
1391 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} | |
1392 | |
1393 % @file, @option are the same as @samp. | |
1394 \let\file=\samp | |
1395 \let\option=\samp | |
1396 | |
1397 % @code is a modification of @t, | |
1398 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. | |
1399 \def\tclose#1{% | |
1400 {% | |
1401 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. | |
1402 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font | |
1403 % | |
1404 % Switch to typewriter. | |
1405 \tt | |
1406 % | |
1407 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. | |
1408 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% | |
1409 % | |
1410 % Turn off hyphenation. | |
1411 \nohyphenation | |
1412 % | |
1413 \rawbackslash | |
1414 \frenchspacing | |
1415 #1% | |
1416 }% | |
1417 \null | |
1418 } | |
1419 | |
1420 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code. | |
1421 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes | |
1422 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. | |
1423 | |
1424 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control | |
1425 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. | |
1426 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) | |
1427 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. | |
1428 % -- rms. | |
1429 { | |
1430 \catcode`\-=\active | |
1431 \catcode`\_=\active | |
1432 % | |
1433 \global\def\code{\begingroup | |
1434 \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash | |
1435 \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder | |
1436 \codex | |
1437 } | |
1438 % | |
1439 % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index, | |
1440 % just treat them as a normal -. | |
1441 \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash} | |
1442 } | |
1443 | |
1444 \def\realdash{-} | |
1445 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1446 \def\codeunder{% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1447 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1448 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1449 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1450 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1451 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1452 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1453 \else\normalunderscore \fi |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1454 \discretionary{}{}{}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1455 {\_}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1456 } |
41418 | 1457 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} |
1458 | |
1459 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, | |
1460 % then @kbd has no effect. | |
1461 | |
1462 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), | |
1463 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), | |
1464 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). | |
1465 \def\kbdinputstyle{\parsearg\kbdinputstylexxx} | |
1466 \def\kbdinputstylexxx#1{% | |
1467 \def\arg{#1}% | |
1468 \ifx\arg\worddistinct | |
1469 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% | |
1470 \else\ifx\arg\wordexample | |
1471 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% | |
1472 \else\ifx\arg\wordcode | |
1473 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% | |
1474 \fi\fi\fi | |
1475 } | |
1476 \def\worddistinct{distinct} | |
1477 \def\wordexample{example} | |
1478 \def\wordcode{code} | |
1479 | |
1480 % Default is kbdinputdistinct. (Too much of a hassle to call the macro, | |
1481 % the catcodes are wrong for parsearg to work.) | |
1482 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl} | |
1483 | |
1484 \def\xkey{\key} | |
1485 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% | |
1486 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% | |
1487 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi | |
1488 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} | |
1489 | |
1490 % For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. | |
1491 \let\url=\code | |
1492 \let\env=\code | |
1493 \let\command=\code | |
1494 | |
1495 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) | |
1496 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third | |
1497 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url | |
1498 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in | |
1499 % a hypertex \special here. | |
1500 % | |
1501 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} | |
1502 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup | |
1503 \unsepspaces | |
1504 \pdfurl{#1}% | |
1505 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
1506 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
1507 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that | |
1508 \else | |
1509 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
1510 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
1511 \ifpdf | |
1512 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it | |
1513 \else | |
1514 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url | |
1515 \fi | |
1516 \else | |
1517 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it | |
1518 \fi | |
1519 \fi | |
1520 \endlink | |
1521 \endgroup} | |
1522 | |
1523 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. | |
1524 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. | |
1525 % | |
1526 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} | |
1527 \ifpdf | |
1528 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} | |
1529 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup | |
1530 \unsepspaces | |
1531 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% | |
1532 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
1533 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi | |
1534 \endlink | |
1535 \endgroup} | |
1536 \else | |
1537 \let\email=\uref | |
1538 \fi | |
1539 | |
1540 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the | |
1541 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and | |
1542 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have | |
1543 % this property, we can check that font parameter. | |
1544 % | |
1545 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } | |
1546 | |
1547 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the | |
1548 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. | |
1549 % | |
1550 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} | |
1551 | |
1552 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} | |
1553 | |
1554 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', | |
1555 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for | |
1556 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. | |
1557 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} | |
1558 | |
1559 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. | |
1560 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font | |
1561 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font | |
1562 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font | |
1563 | |
1564 % @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps. | |
1565 \def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}} | |
1566 | |
1567 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign. | |
1568 \def\pounds{{\it\$}} | |
1569 | |
1570 | |
1571 \message{page headings,} | |
1572 | |
1573 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in | |
1574 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc | |
1575 | |
1576 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. | |
1577 \newif\ifseenauthor | |
1578 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage | |
1579 | |
1580 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the | |
1581 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. | |
1582 % | |
1583 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage | |
1584 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue | |
1585 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage | |
1586 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue | |
1587 | |
1588 \def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz} | |
1589 \def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% | |
1590 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} | |
1591 | |
1592 \def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts | |
1593 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm | |
1594 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}% | |
1595 % | |
1596 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines}% | |
1597 % | |
1598 % Leave some space at the very top of the page. | |
1599 \vglue\titlepagetopglue | |
1600 % | |
1601 % Now you can print the title using @title. | |
1602 \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}% | |
1603 \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefonts\rm ##1} | |
1604 % print a rule at the page bottom also. | |
1605 \finishedtitlepagefalse | |
1606 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}% | |
1607 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. | |
1608 \finishedtitlepagetrue | |
1609 % | |
1610 % Now you can put text using @subtitle. | |
1611 \def\subtitle{\parsearg\subtitlezzz}% | |
1612 \def\subtitlezzz##1{{\subtitlefont \rightline{##1}}}% | |
1613 % | |
1614 % @author should come last, but may come many times. | |
1615 \def\author{\parsearg\authorzzz}% | |
1616 \def\authorzzz##1{\ifseenauthor\else\vskip 0pt plus 1filll\seenauthortrue\fi | |
1617 {\authorfont \leftline{##1}}}% | |
1618 % | |
1619 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space | |
1620 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. | |
1621 \let\oldpage = \page | |
1622 \def\page{% | |
1623 \iffinishedtitlepage\else | |
1624 \finishtitlepage | |
1625 \fi | |
1626 \oldpage | |
1627 \let\page = \oldpage | |
1628 \hbox{}}% | |
1629 % \def\page{\oldpage \hbox{}} | |
1630 } | |
1631 | |
1632 \def\Etitlepage{% | |
1633 \iffinishedtitlepage\else | |
1634 \finishtitlepage | |
1635 \fi | |
1636 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, | |
1637 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. | |
1638 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page | |
1639 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. | |
1640 \oldpage | |
1641 \endgroup | |
1642 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1643 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1644 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1645 \HEADINGSon |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
1646 % |
41418 | 1647 % If they want short, they certainly want long too. |
1648 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage | |
1649 \shortcontents | |
1650 \contents | |
1651 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax | |
1652 \global\let\contents = \relax | |
1653 \fi | |
1654 % | |
1655 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage | |
1656 \contents | |
1657 \global\let\contents = \relax | |
1658 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax | |
1659 \fi | |
1660 } | |
1661 | |
1662 \def\finishtitlepage{% | |
1663 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize | |
1664 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue | |
1665 \finishedtitlepagetrue | |
1666 } | |
1667 | |
1668 %%% Set up page headings and footings. | |
1669 | |
1670 \let\thispage=\folio | |
1671 | |
1672 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages | |
1673 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages | |
1674 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages | |
1675 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages | |
1676 | |
1677 % Now make Tex use those variables | |
1678 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline | |
1679 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} | |
1680 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline | |
1681 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} | |
1682 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax | |
1683 | |
1684 % Commands to set those variables. | |
1685 % For example, this is what @headings on does | |
1686 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter | |
1687 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle | |
1688 % @evenfooting @thisfile|| | |
1689 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile | |
1690 | |
1691 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} | |
1692 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} | |
1693 \def\everyheading{\parsearg\everyheadingxxx} | |
1694 | |
1695 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} | |
1696 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} | |
1697 \def\everyfooting{\parsearg\everyfootingxxx} | |
1698 | |
1699 {\catcode`\@=0 % | |
1700 | |
1701 \gdef\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} | |
1702 \gdef\evenheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% | |
1703 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
1704 | |
1705 \gdef\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} | |
1706 \gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% | |
1707 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
1708 | |
1709 \gdef\everyheadingxxx#1{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% | |
1710 | |
1711 \gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} | |
1712 \gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% | |
1713 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
1714 | |
1715 \gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} | |
1716 \gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% | |
1717 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% | |
1718 % | |
1719 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume | |
1720 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. | |
1721 \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip | |
1722 \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip | |
1723 } | |
1724 | |
1725 \gdef\everyfootingxxx#1{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} | |
1726 % | |
1727 }% unbind the catcode of @. | |
1728 | |
1729 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. | |
1730 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. | |
1731 % @headings off turns them off. | |
1732 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. | |
1733 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. | |
1734 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. | |
1735 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. | |
1736 % By default, they are off at the start of a document, | |
1737 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. | |
1738 | |
1739 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} | |
1740 | |
1741 \def\HEADINGSoff{ | |
1742 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
1743 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}} | |
1744 \HEADINGSoff | |
1745 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. | |
1746 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, | |
1747 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document | |
1748 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top | |
1749 % edge of all pages. | |
1750 \def\HEADINGSdouble{ | |
1751 \global\pageno=1 | |
1752 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
1753 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
1754 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} | |
1755 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1756 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
1757 } | |
1758 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
1759 | |
1760 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, | |
1761 % page number on top right. | |
1762 \def\HEADINGSsingle{ | |
1763 \global\pageno=1 | |
1764 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
1765 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
1766 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1767 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1768 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
1769 } | |
1770 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} | |
1771 | |
1772 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} | |
1773 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter | |
1774 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% | |
1775 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
1776 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
1777 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} | |
1778 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1779 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
1780 } | |
1781 | |
1782 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} | |
1783 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% | |
1784 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
1785 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
1786 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1787 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
1788 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
1789 } | |
1790 | |
1791 % Subroutines used in generating headings | |
1792 % This produces Day Month Year style of output. | |
1793 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set | |
1794 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). | |
1795 \ifx\today\undefined | |
1796 \def\today{% | |
1797 \number\day\space | |
1798 \ifcase\month | |
1799 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr | |
1800 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug | |
1801 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec | |
1802 \fi | |
1803 \space\number\year} | |
1804 \fi | |
1805 | |
1806 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. | |
1807 % It generates no output of its own. | |
1808 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} | |
1809 \def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz} | |
1810 \def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}} | |
1811 | |
1812 | |
1813 \message{tables,} | |
1814 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x). | |
1815 | |
1816 % default indentation of table text | |
1817 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in | |
1818 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text | |
1819 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in | |
1820 % margin between end of table item and start of table text. | |
1821 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in | |
1822 | |
1823 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin | |
1824 \newdimen\itemmax | |
1825 | |
1826 % Note @table, @vtable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with | |
1827 % these defs. | |
1828 % They also define \itemindex | |
1829 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). | |
1830 | |
1831 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip | |
1832 | |
1833 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} | |
1834 | |
1835 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} | |
1836 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} | |
1837 | |
1838 \def\internalBxitem "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \smallbreak \parsearg\xitemzzz} | |
1839 \def\internalBxitemx "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \itemxpar \parsearg\xitemzzz} | |
1840 | |
1841 \def\internalBkitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\kitemzzz} | |
1842 \def\internalBkitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\kitemzzz} | |
1843 | |
1844 \def\kitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \lastfunction}}% | |
1845 \itemzzz {#1}} | |
1846 | |
1847 \def\xitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \xitemsubtopic}}% | |
1848 \itemzzz {#1}} | |
1849 | |
1850 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % | |
1851 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip | |
1852 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent | |
1853 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemfont{#1}}% | |
1854 \itemindex{#1}% | |
1855 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. | |
1856 % | |
1857 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line | |
1858 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that | |
1859 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next | |
1860 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the | |
1861 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. | |
1862 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax | |
1863 % | |
1864 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, | |
1865 % but leave it ragged-right. | |
1866 \begingroup | |
1867 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent | |
1868 \advance\hsize by\tableindent | |
1869 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil | |
1870 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par | |
1871 \endgroup | |
1872 % | |
1873 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the | |
1874 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. | |
1875 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip | |
1876 % | |
1877 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. Unfortunately | |
1878 % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following | |
1879 % \baselineskip glue. | |
1880 \nobreak | |
1881 \endgroup | |
1882 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse | |
1883 \else | |
1884 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the | |
1885 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. | |
1886 \noindent | |
1887 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in | |
1888 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and | |
1889 % eventually be printed. | |
1890 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent | |
1891 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 | |
1892 \unhbox0 | |
1893 \nobreak\kern\dimen0 | |
1894 \endgroup | |
1895 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue | |
1896 \fi | |
1897 } | |
1898 | |
1899 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a table}} | |
1900 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a table}} | |
1901 \def\kitem{\errmessage{@kitem while not in a table}} | |
1902 \def\kitemx{\errmessage{@kitemx while not in a table}} | |
1903 \def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}} | |
1904 \def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}} | |
1905 | |
1906 % Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work. | |
1907 \def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}} | |
1908 | |
1909 % @table, @ftable, @vtable. | |
1910 \def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex} | |
1911 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% | |
1912 \gdef\tablex #1^^M{% | |
1913 \tabley\dontindex#1 \endtabley}} | |
1914 | |
1915 \def\ftable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\ftablex} | |
1916 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% | |
1917 \gdef\ftablex #1^^M{% | |
1918 \tabley\fnitemindex#1 \endtabley | |
1919 \def\Eftable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% | |
1920 \let\Etable=\relax}} | |
1921 | |
1922 \def\vtable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\vtablex} | |
1923 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% | |
1924 \gdef\vtablex #1^^M{% | |
1925 \tabley\vritemindex#1 \endtabley | |
1926 \def\Evtable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% | |
1927 \let\Etable=\relax}} | |
1928 | |
1929 \def\dontindex #1{} | |
1930 \def\fnitemindex #1{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}}% | |
1931 \def\vritemindex #1{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}}% | |
1932 | |
1933 {\obeyspaces % | |
1934 \gdef\tabley#1#2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7\endtabley{\endgroup% | |
1935 \tablez{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}}} | |
1936 | |
1937 \def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{% | |
1938 \aboveenvbreak % | |
1939 \begingroup % | |
1940 \def\Edescription{\Etable}% Necessary kludge. | |
1941 \let\itemindex=#1% | |
1942 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi % | |
1943 \ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi % | |
1944 \ifnum 0#5>0 \advance \rightskip by #5\mil \fi % | |
1945 \def\itemfont{#2}% | |
1946 \itemmax=\tableindent % | |
1947 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin % | |
1948 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent % | |
1949 \exdentamount=\tableindent | |
1950 \parindent = 0pt | |
1951 \parskip = \smallskipamount | |
1952 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi% | |
1953 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% | |
1954 \let\item = \internalBitem % | |
1955 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx % | |
1956 \let\kitem = \internalBkitem % | |
1957 \let\kitemx = \internalBkitemx % | |
1958 \let\xitem = \internalBxitem % | |
1959 \let\xitemx = \internalBxitemx % | |
1960 } | |
1961 | |
1962 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize | |
1963 | |
1964 \newcount \itemno | |
1965 | |
1966 \def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz} | |
1967 | |
1968 \def\itemizezzz #1{% | |
1969 \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize | |
1970 \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize} | |
1971 } | |
1972 | |
1973 \def\itemizey #1#2{% | |
1974 \aboveenvbreak % | |
1975 \itemmax=\itemindent % | |
1976 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin % | |
1977 \advance \leftskip by \itemindent % | |
1978 \exdentamount=\itemindent | |
1979 \parindent = 0pt % | |
1980 \parskip = \smallskipamount % | |
1981 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi% | |
1982 \def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% | |
1983 \def\itemcontents{#1}% | |
1984 \let\item=\itemizeitem} | |
1985 | |
1986 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. | |
1987 % These are `.?!:;,' | |
1988 \def\frenchspacing{\sfcode46=1000 \sfcode63=1000 \sfcode33=1000 | |
1989 \sfcode58=1000 \sfcode59=1000 \sfcode44=1000 } | |
1990 | |
1991 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in | |
1992 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. | |
1993 % | |
1994 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% | |
1995 | |
1996 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, | |
1997 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No | |
1998 % argument is the same as `1'. | |
1999 % | |
2000 \def\enumerate{\parsearg\enumeratezzz} | |
2001 \def\enumeratezzz #1{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} | |
2002 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% | |
2003 \begingroup % ended by the @end enumerate | |
2004 % | |
2005 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. | |
2006 \def\thearg{#1}% | |
2007 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi | |
2008 % | |
2009 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a | |
2010 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. | |
2011 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. | |
2012 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at | |
2013 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) | |
2014 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark | |
2015 \ifx\rest\empty | |
2016 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. | |
2017 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. | |
2018 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and | |
2019 % not equal to itself. | |
2020 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. | |
2021 % | |
2022 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from | |
2023 % continuing to look for a <number>. | |
2024 % | |
2025 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax | |
2026 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) | |
2027 \else | |
2028 % It's a letter. | |
2029 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax | |
2030 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter | |
2031 \else | |
2032 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter | |
2033 \fi | |
2034 \fi | |
2035 \else | |
2036 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. | |
2037 \numericenumerate | |
2038 \fi | |
2039 } | |
2040 | |
2041 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is | |
2042 % given in \thearg. | |
2043 % | |
2044 \def\numericenumerate{% | |
2045 \itemno = \thearg | |
2046 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% | |
2047 } | |
2048 | |
2049 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. | |
2050 \def\lowercaseenumerate{% | |
2051 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg | |
2052 \startenumeration{% | |
2053 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. | |
2054 \ifnum\itemno=0 | |
2055 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger | |
2056 alphabet}% | |
2057 \fi | |
2058 \char\lccode\itemno | |
2059 }% | |
2060 } | |
2061 | |
2062 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. | |
2063 \def\uppercaseenumerate{% | |
2064 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg | |
2065 \startenumeration{% | |
2066 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. | |
2067 \ifnum\itemno=0 | |
2068 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger | |
2069 alphabet} | |
2070 \fi | |
2071 \char\uccode\itemno | |
2072 }% | |
2073 } | |
2074 | |
2075 % Call itemizey, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the | |
2076 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in | |
2077 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. | |
2078 % | |
2079 \def\startenumeration#1{% | |
2080 \advance\itemno by -1 | |
2081 \itemizey{#1.}\Eenumerate\flushcr | |
2082 } | |
2083 | |
2084 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg | |
2085 % to @enumerate. | |
2086 % | |
2087 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} | |
2088 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} | |
2089 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} | |
2090 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} | |
2091 | |
2092 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize. | |
2093 | |
2094 \def\itemizeitem{% | |
2095 \advance\itemno by 1 | |
2096 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% | |
2097 \ifhmode \errmessage{In hmode at itemizeitem}\fi | |
2098 {\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt | |
2099 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}% | |
2100 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% | |
2101 \flushcr} | |
2102 | |
2103 % @multitable macros | |
2104 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 | |
2105 % | |
2106 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. | |
2107 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width | |
2108 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, | |
2109 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. | |
2110 | |
2111 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. | |
2112 | |
2113 % To make preamble: | |
2114 % | |
2115 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: | |
2116 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 | |
2117 % @item ... | |
2118 % | |
2119 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total | |
2120 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many | |
2121 % columns as desired. | |
2122 | |
2123 | |
2124 % Or use a template: | |
2125 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} | |
2126 % @item ... | |
2127 % using the widest term desired in each column. | |
2128 % | |
2129 % For those who want to use more than one line's worth of words in | |
2130 % the preamble, break the line within one argument and it | |
2131 % will parse correctly, i.e., | |
2132 % | |
2133 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 | |
2134 % template} | |
2135 % Not: | |
2136 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} | |
2137 % {Column 3 template} | |
2138 | |
2139 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column | |
2140 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's | |
2141 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, | |
2142 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. | |
2143 | |
2144 % @item, @tab, @multitable or @end multitable do not need to be on their | |
2145 % own lines, but it will not hurt if they are. | |
2146 | |
2147 % Sample multitable: | |
2148 | |
2149 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} | |
2150 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col | |
2151 % @item | |
2152 % first col stuff | |
2153 % @tab | |
2154 % second col stuff | |
2155 % @tab | |
2156 % third col | |
2157 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff | |
2158 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. | |
2159 % | |
2160 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. | |
2161 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. | |
2162 % @end multitable | |
2163 | |
2164 % Default dimensions may be reset by user. | |
2165 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. | |
2166 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. | |
2167 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. | |
2168 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline | |
2169 % to baseline. | |
2170 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. | |
2171 % | |
2172 \newskip\multitableparskip | |
2173 \newskip\multitableparindent | |
2174 \newdimen\multitablecolspace | |
2175 \newskip\multitablelinespace | |
2176 \multitableparskip=0pt | |
2177 \multitableparindent=6pt | |
2178 \multitablecolspace=12pt | |
2179 \multitablelinespace=0pt | |
2180 | |
2181 % Macros used to set up halign preamble: | |
2182 % | |
2183 \let\endsetuptable\relax | |
2184 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} | |
2185 \let\columnfractions\relax | |
2186 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} | |
2187 \newif\ifsetpercent | |
2188 | |
2189 % #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which | |
2190 % is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we | |
2191 % just throw it away). #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the | |
2192 % percent of \hsize for this column. | |
2193 \def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {% | |
2194 \global\advance\colcount by 1 | |
2195 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}% | |
2196 \setuptable | |
2197 } | |
2198 | |
2199 \newcount\colcount | |
2200 \def\setuptable#1{% | |
2201 \def\firstarg{#1}% | |
2202 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable | |
2203 \let\go = \relax | |
2204 \else | |
2205 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions | |
2206 \global\setpercenttrue | |
2207 \else | |
2208 \ifsetpercent | |
2209 \let\go\pickupwholefraction | |
2210 \else | |
2211 \global\advance\colcount by 1 | |
2212 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip }% Add a normal word space as a separator; | |
2213 % typically that is always in the input, anyway. | |
2214 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% | |
2215 \fi | |
2216 \fi | |
2217 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction | |
2218 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so | |
2219 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. | |
2220 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% | |
2221 \else | |
2222 \let\go = \setuptable | |
2223 \fi% | |
2224 \fi | |
2225 \go | |
2226 } | |
2227 | |
2228 % This used to have \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template line is | |
2229 % not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just & until we | |
2230 % encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. | |
2231 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. | |
2232 \def\tab{&} | |
2233 | |
2234 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: | |
2235 % | |
2236 \def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable} | |
2237 \def\dotable#1{\bgroup | |
2238 \vskip\parskip | |
2239 \let\item\crcr | |
2240 \tolerance=9500 | |
2241 \hbadness=9500 | |
2242 \setmultitablespacing | |
2243 \parskip=\multitableparskip | |
2244 \parindent=\multitableparindent | |
2245 \overfullrule=0pt | |
2246 \global\colcount=0 | |
2247 \def\Emultitable{\global\setpercentfalse\cr\egroup\egroup}% | |
2248 % | |
2249 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: | |
2250 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable | |
2251 % | |
2252 % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of | |
2253 % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one. | |
2254 % The table preamble | |
2255 % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width. | |
2256 \everycr{\noalign{% | |
2257 % | |
2258 % \filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. | |
2259 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the table | |
2260 % breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the problem | |
2261 % manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. | |
2262 \global\colcount=0\relax}}% | |
2263 % | |
2264 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will | |
2265 % be used as many times as user calls for columns. | |
2266 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and | |
2267 % continue for many paragraphs if desired. | |
2268 \halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax | |
2269 \multistrut\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname | |
2270 % | |
2271 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other | |
2272 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after | |
2273 % the first one. | |
2274 % | |
2275 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace | |
2276 % to the width of each template entry. | |
2277 % | |
2278 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will | |
2279 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip | |
2280 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at | |
2281 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. | |
2282 % | |
2283 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. | |
2284 \rightskip=0pt | |
2285 \ifnum\colcount=1 | |
2286 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. | |
2287 \advance\hsize by\leftskip | |
2288 \else | |
2289 \ifsetpercent \else | |
2290 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize | |
2291 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. | |
2292 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace | |
2293 \fi | |
2294 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: | |
2295 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace | |
2296 \fi | |
2297 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious | |
2298 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the | |
2299 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. | |
2300 % For example: | |
2301 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 | |
2302 % @item @code{#} | |
2303 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. | |
2304 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively marking | |
2305 % characters. | |
2306 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut}\cr | |
2307 } | |
2308 | |
2309 \def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace. | |
2310 % If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on | |
2311 % current baselineskip. | |
2312 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt | |
2313 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip | |
2314 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 | |
2315 %% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders, | |
2316 %% to keep lines equally spaced | |
2317 \let\multistrut = \strut | |
2318 \else | |
2319 %% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be? | |
2320 \gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0 | |
2321 width0pt\relax} \fi | |
2322 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of | |
2323 %% table. If not, do nothing. | |
2324 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. | |
2325 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace | |
2326 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace | |
2327 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller | |
2328 %% than skip between lines in the table. | |
2329 \fi% | |
2330 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt | |
2331 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace | |
2332 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller | |
2333 %% than skip between lines in the table. | |
2334 \fi} | |
2335 | |
2336 | |
2337 \message{conditionals,} | |
2338 % Prevent errors for section commands. | |
2339 % Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. | |
2340 \def\ignoresections{% | |
2341 \let\chapter=\relax | |
2342 \let\unnumbered=\relax | |
2343 \let\top=\relax | |
2344 \let\unnumberedsec=\relax | |
2345 \let\unnumberedsection=\relax | |
2346 \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax | |
2347 \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax | |
2348 \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax | |
2349 \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax | |
2350 \let\section=\relax | |
2351 \let\subsec=\relax | |
2352 \let\subsubsec=\relax | |
2353 \let\subsection=\relax | |
2354 \let\subsubsection=\relax | |
2355 \let\appendix=\relax | |
2356 \let\appendixsec=\relax | |
2357 \let\appendixsection=\relax | |
2358 \let\appendixsubsec=\relax | |
2359 \let\appendixsubsection=\relax | |
2360 \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax | |
2361 \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax | |
2362 \let\contents=\relax | |
2363 \let\smallbook=\relax | |
2364 \let\titlepage=\relax | |
2365 } | |
2366 | |
2367 % Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source | |
2368 % and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used | |
2369 % incorrectly. | |
2370 % | |
2371 \def\ignoremorecommands{% | |
2372 \let\defcodeindex = \relax | |
2373 \let\defcv = \relax | |
2374 \let\deffn = \relax | |
2375 \let\deffnx = \relax | |
2376 \let\defindex = \relax | |
2377 \let\defivar = \relax | |
2378 \let\defmac = \relax | |
2379 \let\defmethod = \relax | |
2380 \let\defop = \relax | |
2381 \let\defopt = \relax | |
2382 \let\defspec = \relax | |
2383 \let\deftp = \relax | |
2384 \let\deftypefn = \relax | |
2385 \let\deftypefun = \relax | |
2386 \let\deftypeivar = \relax | |
2387 \let\deftypeop = \relax | |
2388 \let\deftypevar = \relax | |
2389 \let\deftypevr = \relax | |
2390 \let\defun = \relax | |
2391 \let\defvar = \relax | |
2392 \let\defvr = \relax | |
2393 \let\ref = \relax | |
2394 \let\xref = \relax | |
2395 \let\printindex = \relax | |
2396 \let\pxref = \relax | |
2397 \let\settitle = \relax | |
2398 \let\setchapternewpage = \relax | |
2399 \let\setchapterstyle = \relax | |
2400 \let\everyheading = \relax | |
2401 \let\evenheading = \relax | |
2402 \let\oddheading = \relax | |
2403 \let\everyfooting = \relax | |
2404 \let\evenfooting = \relax | |
2405 \let\oddfooting = \relax | |
2406 \let\headings = \relax | |
2407 \let\include = \relax | |
2408 \let\lowersections = \relax | |
2409 \let\down = \relax | |
2410 \let\raisesections = \relax | |
2411 \let\up = \relax | |
2412 \let\set = \relax | |
2413 \let\clear = \relax | |
2414 \let\item = \relax | |
2415 } | |
2416 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2417 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, @ifplaintext, @ifnottex, @html, @menu, |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2418 % @direntry, and @documentdescription. |
41418 | 2419 % |
2420 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2421 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} |
41418 | 2422 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2423 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} |
41418 | 2424 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} |
2425 \def\html{\doignore{html}} | |
2426 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} | |
2427 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2428 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2429 \def\documentdescriptionword{documentdescription} |
41418 | 2430 |
2431 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file | |
2432 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. | |
2433 \let\dircategory = \comment | |
2434 | |
2435 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1'. | |
2436 % | |
2437 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup | |
2438 % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. | |
2439 \ignoresections | |
2440 % | |
2441 % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'. | |
2442 % This @ is a catcode 12 token (that is the normal catcode of @ in | |
2443 % this texinfo.tex file). We change the catcode of @ below to match. | |
2444 \long\def\doignoretext##1@end #1{\enddoignore}% | |
2445 % | |
2446 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. | |
2447 \catcode32 = 10 | |
2448 % | |
2449 % Ignore braces, too, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble. | |
2450 \catcode`\{ = 9 | |
2451 \catcode`\} = 9 | |
2452 % | |
2453 % We must not have @c interpreted as a control sequence. | |
2454 \catcode`\@ = 12 | |
2455 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2456 \def\ignoreword{#1}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2457 \ifx\ignoreword\documentdescriptionword |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2458 % The c kludge breaks documentdescription, since |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2459 % `documentdescription' contains a `c'. Means not everything will |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2460 % be ignored inside @documentdescription, but oh well... |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2461 \else |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2462 % Make the letter c a comment character so that the rest of the line |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2463 % will be ignored. This way, the document can have (for example) |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2464 % @c @end ifinfo |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2465 % and the @end ifinfo will be properly ignored. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2466 % (We've just changed @ to catcode 12.) |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2467 \catcode`\c = 14 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2468 \fi |
41418 | 2469 % |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2470 % And now expand the command defined above. |
41418 | 2471 \doignoretext |
2472 } | |
2473 | |
2474 % What we do to finish off ignored text. | |
2475 % | |
2476 \def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% | |
2477 | |
2478 \newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse | |
2479 \def\obstexwarn{% | |
2480 \ifwarnedobs\relax\else | |
2481 % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0. | |
2482 % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines. | |
2483 \immediate\write16{} | |
2484 \immediate\write16{WARNING: for users of Unix TeX 3.0!} | |
2485 \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).} | |
2486 \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.} | |
2487 \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.} | |
2488 \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.} | |
2489 \immediate\write16{ (See ftp://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/TeX.README.)} | |
2490 \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the} | |
2491 \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution} | |
2492 \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.} | |
2493 \immediate\write16{} | |
2494 \global\warnedobstrue | |
2495 \fi | |
2496 } | |
2497 | |
2498 % **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a | |
2499 % workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed), | |
2500 % uncomment the following line: | |
2501 %%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax | |
2502 | |
2503 % Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for | |
2504 % purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command. | |
2505 % | |
2506 \def\nestedignore#1{% | |
2507 \obstexwarn | |
2508 % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end | |
2509 % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the | |
2510 % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize | |
2511 % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on | |
2512 % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font. | |
2513 % | |
2514 \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup | |
2515 % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. | |
2516 \ignoresections | |
2517 % | |
2518 % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the | |
2519 % @end command again. | |
2520 \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}% | |
2521 % | |
2522 % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no | |
2523 % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do | |
2524 % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we | |
2525 % undefine them. | |
2526 % | |
2527 % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately; | |
2528 % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors. | |
2529 \ignoremorecommands | |
2530 % | |
2531 % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define | |
2532 % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use | |
2533 % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites | |
2534 % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still | |
2535 % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of | |
2536 % stuff compared to the main input. | |
2537 % | |
2538 \nullfont | |
2539 \let\tenrm=\nullfont \let\tenit=\nullfont \let\tensl=\nullfont | |
2540 \let\tenbf=\nullfont \let\tentt=\nullfont \let\smallcaps=\nullfont | |
2541 \let\tensf=\nullfont | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2542 % Similarly for index fonts. |
41418 | 2543 \let\smallrm=\nullfont \let\smallit=\nullfont \let\smallsl=\nullfont |
2544 \let\smallbf=\nullfont \let\smalltt=\nullfont \let\smallsc=\nullfont | |
2545 \let\smallsf=\nullfont | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2546 % Similarly for smallexample fonts. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2547 \let\smallerrm=\nullfont \let\smallerit=\nullfont \let\smallersl=\nullfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2548 \let\smallerbf=\nullfont \let\smallertt=\nullfont \let\smallersc=\nullfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2549 \let\smallersf=\nullfont |
41418 | 2550 % |
2551 % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts. | |
2552 \tracinglostchars = 0 | |
2553 % | |
2554 % Don't bother to do space factor calculations. | |
2555 \frenchspacing | |
2556 % | |
2557 % Don't report underfull hboxes. | |
2558 \hbadness = 10000 | |
2559 % | |
2560 % Do minimal line-breaking. | |
2561 \pretolerance = 10000 | |
2562 % | |
2563 % Do not execute instructions in @tex | |
2564 \def\tex{\doignore{tex}}% | |
2565 % Do not execute macro definitions. | |
2566 % `c' is a comment character, so the word `macro' will get cut off. | |
2567 \def\macro{\doignore{ma}}% | |
2568 } | |
2569 | |
2570 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. | |
2571 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. | |
2572 % | |
2573 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be | |
2574 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our | |
2575 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we | |
2576 % didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid | |
2577 % losing inside @example, for instance. | |
2578 % | |
2579 \def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10 | |
2580 \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. | |
2581 \parsearg\setxxx} | |
2582 \def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} | |
2583 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% | |
2584 \def\temp{#2}% | |
2585 \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty | |
2586 \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. | |
2587 \fi | |
2588 \endgroup | |
2589 } | |
2590 % Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or | |
2591 % \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into | |
2592 % an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. | |
2593 \def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} | |
2594 | |
2595 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. | |
2596 % | |
2597 \def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} | |
2598 \def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} | |
2599 | |
2600 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. | |
2601 { | |
2602 \catcode`\_ = \active | |
2603 % | |
2604 % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if | |
2605 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}. So \let any | |
2606 % such active characters to their normal equivalents. | |
2607 \gdef\value{\begingroup | |
2608 \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 | |
2609 \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore | |
2610 \valuexxx} | |
2611 } | |
2612 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} | |
2613 | |
2614 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's | |
2615 % properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies). Ones | |
2616 % whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything | |
2617 % about that. The command has to be fully expandable, since the result | |
2618 % winds up in the index file. This means that if the variable's value | |
2619 % contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain it will fail | |
2620 % (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work to do a | |
2621 % one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). | |
2622 % | |
2623 \def\expandablevalue#1{% | |
2624 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax | |
2625 {[No value for ``#1'']}% | |
2626 \else | |
2627 \csname SET#1\endcsname | |
2628 \fi | |
2629 } | |
2630 | |
2631 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined | |
2632 % with @set. | |
2633 % | |
2634 \def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx} | |
2635 \def\ifsetxxx #1{% | |
2636 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax | |
2637 \expandafter\ifsetfail | |
2638 \else | |
2639 \expandafter\ifsetsucceed | |
2640 \fi | |
2641 } | |
2642 \def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} | |
2643 \def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}} | |
2644 \defineunmatchedend{ifset} | |
2645 | |
2646 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been | |
2647 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. | |
2648 % | |
2649 \def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx} | |
2650 \def\ifclearxxx #1{% | |
2651 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax | |
2652 \expandafter\ifclearsucceed | |
2653 \else | |
2654 \expandafter\ifclearfail | |
2655 \fi | |
2656 } | |
2657 \def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} | |
2658 \def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}} | |
2659 \defineunmatchedend{ifclear} | |
2660 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2661 % @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext always succeed; we |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2662 % read the text following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2663 % `@end iftex' (etc.) valid only after an @iftex. |
41418 | 2664 % |
2665 \def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} | |
2666 \def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}} | |
2667 \def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2668 \def\ifnotplaintext{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotplaintext}} |
41418 | 2669 \defineunmatchedend{iftex} |
2670 \defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml} | |
2671 \defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2672 \defineunmatchedend{ifnotplaintext} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2673 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2674 % We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (etc.) and end it at |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2675 % @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no |
41418 | 2676 % effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must |
2677 % define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't | |
2678 % just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since | |
2679 % the @ifset might be nested.) | |
2680 % | |
2681 \def\conditionalsucceed#1{% | |
2682 \edef\temp{% | |
2683 % Remember the current value of \E#1. | |
2684 \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}% | |
2685 % | |
2686 % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value. | |
2687 \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}% | |
2688 }% | |
2689 \temp | |
2690 } | |
2691 | |
2692 % We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the | |
2693 % control sequences after we've constructed them. | |
2694 % | |
2695 \def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} | |
2696 | |
2697 % @defininfoenclose. | |
2698 \let\definfoenclose=\comment | |
2699 | |
2700 | |
2701 \message{indexing,} | |
2702 % Index generation facilities | |
2703 | |
2704 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite | |
2705 % except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex. | |
2706 {\catcode`\@=11 | |
2707 \gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}} | |
2708 | |
2709 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. | |
2710 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that | |
2711 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. | |
2712 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for | |
2713 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. | |
2714 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long | |
2715 % for the sake of vms. | |
2716 % | |
2717 \def\newindex#1{% | |
2718 \iflinks | |
2719 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname | |
2720 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file | |
2721 \fi | |
2722 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index | |
2723 \noexpand\doindex{#1}} | |
2724 } | |
2725 | |
2726 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} | |
2727 % | |
2728 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} | |
2729 | |
2730 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. | |
2731 % | |
2732 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} | |
2733 % | |
2734 \def\newcodeindex#1{% | |
2735 \iflinks | |
2736 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname | |
2737 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 | |
2738 \fi | |
2739 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% | |
2740 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% | |
2741 } | |
2742 | |
2743 | |
2744 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. | |
2745 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. | |
2746 % | |
2747 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo | |
2748 % inside @code. | |
2749 % | |
2750 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} | |
2751 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} | |
2752 | |
2753 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), | |
2754 % #3 the target index (bar). | |
2755 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% | |
2756 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up | |
2757 % closing the target index. | |
2758 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined | |
2759 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the | |
2760 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. | |
2761 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname | |
2762 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 | |
2763 \fi | |
2764 % redefine \fooindfile: | |
2765 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname | |
2766 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp | |
2767 % redefine \fooindex: | |
2768 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% | |
2769 } | |
2770 | |
2771 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. | |
2772 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, | |
2773 % and it is "foo", the name of the index. | |
2774 | |
2775 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. | |
2776 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. | |
2777 | |
2778 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} | |
2779 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. | |
2780 | |
2781 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} | |
2782 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} | |
2783 | |
2784 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. | |
2785 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} | |
2786 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} | |
2787 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2788 % Take care of texinfo commands likely to appear in an index entry. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2789 % (Must be a way to avoid doing expansion at all, and thus not have to |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2790 % laboriously list every single command here.) |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2791 % |
41418 | 2792 \def\indexdummies{% |
2793 \def\ { }% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2794 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in aux files. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2795 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2796 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2797 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2798 \let\{ = \mylbrace |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2799 \let\} = \myrbrace |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2800 \def\_{{\realbackslash _}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2801 \normalturnoffactive |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2802 % |
41418 | 2803 % Take care of the plain tex accent commands. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2804 \def\,##1{\realbackslash ,{##1}}% |
41418 | 2805 \def\"{\realbackslash "}% |
2806 \def\`{\realbackslash `}% | |
2807 \def\'{\realbackslash '}% | |
2808 \def\^{\realbackslash ^}% | |
2809 \def\~{\realbackslash ~}% | |
2810 \def\={\realbackslash =}% | |
2811 \def\b{\realbackslash b}% | |
2812 \def\c{\realbackslash c}% | |
2813 \def\d{\realbackslash d}% | |
2814 \def\u{\realbackslash u}% | |
2815 \def\v{\realbackslash v}% | |
2816 \def\H{\realbackslash H}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2817 \def\dotless##1{\realbackslash dotless {##1}}% |
41418 | 2818 % Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2819 \def\AA{\realbackslash AA}% |
41418 | 2820 \def\AE{\realbackslash AE}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2821 \def\L{\realbackslash L}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2822 \def\OE{\realbackslash OE}% |
41418 | 2823 \def\O{\realbackslash O}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2824 \def\aa{\realbackslash aa}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2825 \def\ae{\realbackslash ae}% |
41418 | 2826 \def\l{\realbackslash l}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2827 \def\oe{\realbackslash oe}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2828 \def\o{\realbackslash o}% |
41418 | 2829 \def\ss{\realbackslash ss}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2830 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2831 % Although these internals commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. |
41418 | 2832 \def\bf{\realbackslash bf }% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2833 \def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2834 \def\hat{\realbackslash hat}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2835 \def\less{\realbackslash less}% |
41418 | 2836 %\def\rm{\realbackslash rm }% |
2837 \def\sf{\realbackslash sf}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2838 \def\sl{\realbackslash sl }% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2839 \def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}% |
41418 | 2840 \def\tt{\realbackslash tt}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2841 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2842 \def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2843 \def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2844 \def\sc##1{\realbackslash sc {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2845 \def\t##1{\realbackslash t {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2846 \def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2847 % |
41418 | 2848 \def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2849 \def\acronym##1{\realbackslash acronym {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2850 \def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2851 \def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2852 \def\command##1{\realbackslash command {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2853 \def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}% |
41418 | 2854 \def\dots{\realbackslash dots }% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2855 \def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2856 \def\env##1{\realbackslash env {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2857 \def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2858 \def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2859 \def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2860 \def\math##1{\realbackslash math {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2861 \def\option##1{\realbackslash option {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2862 \def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2863 \def\strong##1{\realbackslash strong {##1}}% |
41418 | 2864 \def\uref##1{\realbackslash uref {##1}}% |
2865 \def\url##1{\realbackslash url {##1}}% | |
2866 \def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2867 \def\w{\realbackslash w }% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2868 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2869 % These math commands don't seem likely to be used in index entries. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2870 \def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2871 \def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2872 \def\error{\realbackslash error}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2873 \def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2874 \def\point{\realbackslash point}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2875 \def\print{\realbackslash print}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2876 \def\result{\realbackslash result}% |
41418 | 2877 % |
2878 % Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not | |
2879 % contain - or _, and the value does not contain any | |
2880 % (non-fully-expandable) commands. | |
2881 \let\value = \expandablevalue | |
2882 % | |
2883 \unsepspaces | |
2884 % Turn off macro expansion | |
2885 \turnoffmacros | |
2886 } | |
2887 | |
2888 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces | |
2889 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2890 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). |
41418 | 2891 {\obeyspaces |
2892 \gdef\unsepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\space}} | |
2893 | |
2894 % \indexnofonts no-ops all font-change commands. | |
2895 % This is used when outputting the strings to sort the index by. | |
2896 \def\indexdummyfont#1{#1} | |
2897 \def\indexdummytex{TeX} | |
2898 \def\indexdummydots{...} | |
2899 | |
2900 \def\indexnofonts{% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2901 \def\@{@}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2902 % how to handle braces? |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2903 \def\_{\normalunderscore}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2904 % |
41418 | 2905 \let\,=\indexdummyfont |
2906 \let\"=\indexdummyfont | |
2907 \let\`=\indexdummyfont | |
2908 \let\'=\indexdummyfont | |
2909 \let\^=\indexdummyfont | |
2910 \let\~=\indexdummyfont | |
2911 \let\==\indexdummyfont | |
2912 \let\b=\indexdummyfont | |
2913 \let\c=\indexdummyfont | |
2914 \let\d=\indexdummyfont | |
2915 \let\u=\indexdummyfont | |
2916 \let\v=\indexdummyfont | |
2917 \let\H=\indexdummyfont | |
2918 \let\dotless=\indexdummyfont | |
2919 % Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters. | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2920 \def\AA{AA}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2921 \def\AE{AE}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2922 \def\L{L}% |
41418 | 2923 \def\OE{OE}% |
2924 \def\O{O}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2925 \def\aa{aa}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2926 \def\ae{ae}% |
41418 | 2927 \def\l{l}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2928 \def\oe{oe}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2929 \def\o{o}% |
41418 | 2930 \def\ss{ss}% |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2931 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2932 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2933 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2934 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2935 %\let\tt=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2936 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2937 \let\b=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2938 \let\i=\indexdummyfont |
41418 | 2939 \let\r=\indexdummyfont |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2940 \let\sc=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2941 \let\t=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2942 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2943 \let\TeX=\indexdummytex |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2944 \let\acronym=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2945 \let\cite=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2946 \let\code=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2947 \let\command=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2948 \let\dfn=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2949 \let\dots=\indexdummydots |
41418 | 2950 \let\emph=\indexdummyfont |
2951 \let\env=\indexdummyfont | |
2952 \let\file=\indexdummyfont | |
2953 \let\kbd=\indexdummyfont | |
2954 \let\key=\indexdummyfont | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2955 \let\math=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2956 \let\option=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2957 \let\samp=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2958 \let\strong=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2959 \let\uref=\indexdummyfont |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2960 \let\url=\indexdummyfont |
41418 | 2961 \let\var=\indexdummyfont |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
2962 \let\w=\indexdummyfont |
41418 | 2963 } |
2964 | |
2965 % To define \realbackslash, we must make \ not be an escape. | |
2966 % We must first make another character (@) an escape | |
2967 % so we do not become unable to do a definition. | |
2968 | |
2969 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other | |
2970 @gdef@realbackslash{\}} | |
2971 | |
2972 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. | |
2973 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? | |
2974 | |
2975 % For \ifx comparisons. | |
2976 \def\emptymacro{\empty} | |
2977 | |
2978 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. | |
2979 % | |
2980 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}\empty} | |
2981 | |
2982 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. | |
2983 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- | |
2984 % \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are. The main exception | |
2985 % is with defuns, which call us directly. | |
2986 % | |
2987 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% | |
2988 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. | |
2989 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else | |
2990 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}% | |
2991 \fi | |
2992 {% | |
2993 \count255=\lastpenalty | |
2994 {% | |
2995 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage | |
2996 \escapechar=`\\ | |
2997 {% | |
2998 \let\folio = 0% We will expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio. | |
2999 \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now | |
3000 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. | |
3001 % | |
3002 \def\thirdarg{#3}% | |
3003 % | |
3004 % If third arg is present, precede it with space in sort key. | |
3005 \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro | |
3006 \let\subentry = \empty | |
3007 \else | |
3008 \def\subentry{ #3}% | |
3009 \fi | |
3010 % | |
3011 % First process the index entry with all font commands turned | |
3012 % off to get the string to sort by. | |
3013 {\indexnofonts \xdef\indexsorttmp{#2\subentry}}% | |
3014 % | |
3015 % Now the real index entry with the fonts. | |
3016 \toks0 = {#2}% | |
3017 % | |
3018 % If the third (subentry) arg is present, add it to the index | |
3019 % line to write. | |
3020 \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro \else | |
3021 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0{#3}}% | |
3022 \fi | |
3023 % | |
3024 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and | |
3025 % the original text, including any font commands. We write | |
3026 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the | |
3027 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s | |
3028 % sorted result. | |
3029 \edef\temp{% | |
3030 \write\csname#1indfile\endcsname{% | |
3031 \realbackslash entry{\indexsorttmp}{\folio}{\the\toks0}}% | |
3032 }% | |
3033 % | |
3034 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it | |
3035 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting | |
3036 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the | |
3037 % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences | |
3038 % like this: | |
3039 % @end defun | |
3040 % @tindex whatever | |
3041 % @defun ... | |
3042 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the | |
3043 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of | |
3044 % the previous defun. | |
3045 % | |
3046 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We | |
3047 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. | |
3048 % | |
3049 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. | |
3050 % | |
3051 \iflinks | |
3052 \ifvmode | |
3053 \skip0 = \lastskip | |
3054 \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip-\lastskip \fi | |
3055 \fi | |
3056 % | |
3057 \temp % do the write | |
3058 % | |
3059 % | |
3060 \ifvmode \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip\skip0 \fi \fi | |
3061 \fi | |
3062 }% | |
3063 }% | |
3064 \penalty\count255 | |
3065 }% | |
3066 } | |
3067 | |
3068 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like | |
3069 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} | |
3070 % or | |
3071 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} | |
3072 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files | |
3073 % containing these kinds of lines: | |
3074 % \initial {c} | |
3075 % before the first topic whose initial is c | |
3076 % \entry {topic}{pagelist} | |
3077 % for a topic that is used without subtopics | |
3078 % \primary {topic} | |
3079 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics | |
3080 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} | |
3081 % for each subtopic. | |
3082 | |
3083 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands | |
3084 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. | |
3085 | |
3086 \def\findex {\fnindex} | |
3087 \def\kindex {\kyindex} | |
3088 \def\cindex {\cpindex} | |
3089 \def\vindex {\vrindex} | |
3090 \def\tindex {\tpindex} | |
3091 \def\pindex {\pgindex} | |
3092 | |
3093 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} | |
3094 {\obeylines % | |
3095 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % | |
3096 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} | |
3097 | |
3098 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. | |
3099 | |
3100 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. | |
3101 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). | |
3102 % | |
3103 \def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex} | |
3104 \def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup | |
3105 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% | |
3106 % | |
3107 \smallfonts \rm | |
3108 \tolerance = 9500 | |
3109 \indexbreaks | |
3110 % | |
3111 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. | |
3112 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains | |
3113 % \initial {@} | |
3114 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces | |
3115 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). | |
3116 \catcode`\@ = 11 | |
3117 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s | |
3118 \ifeof 1 | |
3119 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, | |
3120 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the | |
3121 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure | |
3122 % there is some text. | |
3123 \putwordIndexNonexistent | |
3124 \else | |
3125 % | |
3126 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof | |
3127 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so | |
3128 % it can discover if there is anything in it. | |
3129 \read 1 to \temp | |
3130 \ifeof 1 | |
3131 \putwordIndexIsEmpty | |
3132 \else | |
3133 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape | |
3134 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change | |
3135 % to make right now. | |
3136 \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}% | |
3137 \catcode`\\ = 0 | |
3138 \escapechar = `\\ | |
3139 \begindoublecolumns | |
3140 \input \jobname.#1s | |
3141 \enddoublecolumns | |
3142 \fi | |
3143 \fi | |
3144 \closein 1 | |
3145 \endgroup} | |
3146 | |
3147 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. | |
3148 % Change them to control the appearance of the index. | |
3149 | |
3150 \def\initial#1{{% | |
3151 % Some minor font changes for the special characters. | |
3152 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt | |
3153 % | |
3154 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. | |
3155 \removelastskip | |
3156 % | |
3157 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. | |
3158 \penalty -300 | |
3159 % | |
3160 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of | |
3161 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column | |
3162 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch | |
3163 % we need before each entry, but it's better. | |
3164 % | |
3165 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. | |
3166 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip | |
3167 \leftline{\secbf #1}% | |
3168 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip | |
3169 % | |
3170 % Do our best not to break after the initial. | |
3171 \nobreak | |
3172 }} | |
3173 | |
3174 % This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2 | |
3175 % flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents | |
3176 % entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. | |
3177 % | |
3178 \def\entry#1#2{\begingroup | |
3179 % | |
3180 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't | |
3181 % affect previous text. | |
3182 \par | |
3183 % | |
3184 % Do not fill out the last line with white space. | |
3185 \parfillskip = 0in | |
3186 % | |
3187 % No extra space above this paragraph. | |
3188 \parskip = 0in | |
3189 % | |
3190 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. | |
3191 \finalhyphendemerits = 0 | |
3192 % | |
3193 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number | |
3194 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the | |
3195 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large | |
3196 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across | |
3197 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. | |
3198 % | |
3199 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start | |
3200 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. | |
3201 \hangindent = 2em | |
3202 % | |
3203 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line | |
3204 % with blank space. | |
3205 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil | |
3206 % | |
3207 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns. | |
3208 \vskip 0pt plus1pt | |
3209 % | |
3210 % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking | |
3211 % parameters we've set above will have an effect. | |
3212 \noindent | |
3213 % | |
3214 % Insert the text of the index entry. TeX will do line-breaking on it. | |
3215 #1% | |
3216 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if | |
3217 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be | |
3218 % cursed by a Unix daemon. | |
3219 \def\tempa{{\rm }}% | |
3220 \def\tempb{#2}% | |
3221 \edef\tempc{\tempa}% | |
3222 \edef\tempd{\tempb}% | |
3223 \ifx\tempc\tempd\ \else% | |
3224 % | |
3225 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out | |
3226 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the | |
3227 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) | |
3228 \hfil\penalty50 | |
3229 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. | |
3230 % | |
3231 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as | |
3232 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull | |
3233 % \hbox ensues. | |
3234 \ifpdf | |
3235 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. | |
3236 \else | |
3237 \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. | |
3238 \fi | |
3239 \fi% | |
3240 \par | |
3241 \endgroup} | |
3242 | |
3243 % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em. | |
3244 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders | |
3245 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} | |
3246 | |
3247 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} | |
3248 | |
3249 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm | |
3250 \def\secondary#1#2{{% | |
3251 \parfillskip=0in | |
3252 \parskip=0in | |
3253 \hangindent=1in | |
3254 \hangafter=1 | |
3255 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill | |
3256 \ifpdf | |
3257 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. | |
3258 \else | |
3259 #2 | |
3260 \fi | |
3261 \par | |
3262 }} | |
3263 | |
3264 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. | |
3265 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, | |
3266 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. | |
3267 \catcode`\@=11 | |
3268 | |
3269 \newbox\partialpage | |
3270 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize | |
3271 | |
3272 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns | |
3273 % Grab any single-column material above us. | |
3274 \output = {% | |
3275 % | |
3276 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a | |
3277 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output | |
3278 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is | |
3279 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In | |
3280 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal | |
3281 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this | |
3282 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. | |
3283 \ifvoid\partialpage \else | |
3284 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% | |
3285 \fi | |
3286 % | |
3287 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% | |
3288 % Unvbox the main output page. | |
3289 \unvbox\PAGE | |
3290 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip | |
3291 }% | |
3292 }% | |
3293 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage | |
3294 % | |
3295 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. | |
3296 \output = {\doublecolumnout}% | |
3297 % | |
3298 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this | |
3299 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 | |
3300 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple | |
3301 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the | |
3302 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. | |
3303 % | |
3304 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between | |
3305 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it | |
3306 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant | |
3307 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) | |
3308 % as it did when we hard-coded it. | |
3309 % | |
3310 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we | |
3311 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) | |
3312 % been clobbered. | |
3313 % | |
3314 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize | |
3315 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize | |
3316 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 | |
3317 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize | |
3318 % | |
3319 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, | |
3320 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) | |
3321 \vsize = 2\vsize | |
3322 } | |
3323 | |
3324 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except | |
3325 % the last. | |
3326 % | |
3327 \def\doublecolumnout{% | |
3328 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth | |
3329 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal | |
3330 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the | |
3331 % previous page. | |
3332 \dimen@ = \vsize | |
3333 \divide\dimen@ by 2 | |
3334 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage | |
3335 % | |
3336 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. | |
3337 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ | |
3338 \onepageout\pagesofar | |
3339 \unvbox255 | |
3340 \penalty\outputpenalty | |
3341 } | |
3342 % | |
3343 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, | |
3344 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. | |
3345 \def\pagesofar{% | |
3346 \unvbox\partialpage | |
3347 % | |
3348 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize | |
3349 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize | |
3350 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% | |
3351 } | |
3352 % | |
3353 % All done with double columns. | |
3354 \def\enddoublecolumns{% | |
3355 \output = {% | |
3356 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the | |
3357 % current page, no automatic page break. | |
3358 \balancecolumns | |
3359 % | |
3360 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, | |
3361 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output | |
3362 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not | |
3363 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal | |
3364 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be | |
3365 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes | |
3366 % the output somewhat more palatable.) | |
3367 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% | |
3368 }% | |
3369 \eject | |
3370 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns | |
3371 % | |
3372 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted | |
3373 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column | |
3374 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the | |
3375 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). | |
3376 \pagegoal = \vsize | |
3377 } | |
3378 % | |
3379 % Called at the end of the double column material. | |
3380 \def\balancecolumns{% | |
3381 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. | |
3382 \dimen@ = \ht0 | |
3383 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip | |
3384 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip | |
3385 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to | |
3386 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% | |
3387 \splittopskip = \topskip | |
3388 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. | |
3389 {% | |
3390 \vbadness = 10000 | |
3391 \loop | |
3392 \global\setbox3 = \copy0 | |
3393 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ | |
3394 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ | |
3395 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt | |
3396 \repeat | |
3397 }% | |
3398 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% | |
3399 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% | |
3400 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% | |
3401 % | |
3402 \pagesofar | |
3403 } | |
3404 \catcode`\@ = \other | |
3405 | |
3406 | |
3407 \message{sectioning,} | |
3408 % Chapters, sections, etc. | |
3409 | |
3410 \newcount\chapno | |
3411 \newcount\secno \secno=0 | |
3412 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 | |
3413 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 | |
3414 | |
3415 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... | |
3416 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ | |
3417 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} | |
3418 % We do the following for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual | |
3419 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. | |
3420 \def\appendixletter{% | |
3421 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% | |
3422 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% | |
3423 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% | |
3424 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% | |
3425 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% | |
3426 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% | |
3427 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% | |
3428 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% | |
3429 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% | |
3430 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% | |
3431 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% | |
3432 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% | |
3433 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% | |
3434 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% | |
3435 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% | |
3436 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% | |
3437 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% | |
3438 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% | |
3439 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% | |
3440 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% | |
3441 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% | |
3442 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% | |
3443 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% | |
3444 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% | |
3445 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% | |
3446 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% | |
3447 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is | |
3448 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not | |
3449 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out | |
3450 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. | |
3451 \else\char\the\appendixno | |
3452 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi | |
3453 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} | |
3454 | |
3455 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. | |
3456 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. | |
3457 \def\thischapter{} | |
3458 \def\thissection{} | |
3459 | |
3460 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level | |
3461 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count | |
3462 | |
3463 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. | |
3464 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} | |
3465 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name | |
3466 | |
3467 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. | |
3468 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} | |
3469 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name | |
3470 | |
3471 % Choose a numbered-heading macro | |
3472 % #1 is heading level if unmodified by @raisesections or @lowersections | |
3473 % #2 is text for heading | |
3474 \def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 | |
3475 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
3476 \chapterzzz{#2} | |
3477 \or | |
3478 \seczzz{#2} | |
3479 \or | |
3480 \numberedsubseczzz{#2} | |
3481 \or | |
3482 \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3483 \else | |
3484 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 | |
3485 \chapterzzz{#2} | |
3486 \else | |
3487 \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3488 \fi | |
3489 \fi | |
3490 } | |
3491 | |
3492 % like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels | |
3493 \def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 | |
3494 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
3495 \appendixzzz{#2} | |
3496 \or | |
3497 \appendixsectionzzz{#2} | |
3498 \or | |
3499 \appendixsubseczzz{#2} | |
3500 \or | |
3501 \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3502 \else | |
3503 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 | |
3504 \appendixzzz{#2} | |
3505 \else | |
3506 \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3507 \fi | |
3508 \fi | |
3509 } | |
3510 | |
3511 % like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels | |
3512 \def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 | |
3513 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
3514 \unnumberedzzz{#2} | |
3515 \or | |
3516 \unnumberedseczzz{#2} | |
3517 \or | |
3518 \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2} | |
3519 \or | |
3520 \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3521 \else | |
3522 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 | |
3523 \unnumberedzzz{#2} | |
3524 \else | |
3525 \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} | |
3526 \fi | |
3527 \fi | |
3528 } | |
3529 | |
3530 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. | |
3531 \def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title} | |
3532 \outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy} | |
3533 \def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz | |
3534 \def\chapterzzz #1{% | |
3535 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 | |
3536 \global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% | |
3537 \chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}% | |
3538 \gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3539 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% | |
3540 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter | |
3541 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. | |
3542 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}% | |
3543 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3544 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3545 {\the\chapno}}}% | |
3546 \temp | |
3547 \donoderef | |
3548 \global\let\section = \numberedsec | |
3549 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec | |
3550 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec | |
3551 } | |
3552 | |
3553 \outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy} | |
3554 \def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz | |
3555 \def\appendixzzz #1{% | |
3556 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 | |
3557 \global\advance \appendixno by 1 | |
3558 \message{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% | |
3559 \chapmacro {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}% | |
3560 \gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3561 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% | |
3562 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}% | |
3563 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3564 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash appendixentry{\the\toks0}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3565 {\appendixletter}}}% |
41418 | 3566 \temp |
3567 \appendixnoderef | |
3568 \global\let\section = \appendixsec | |
3569 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec | |
3570 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec | |
3571 } | |
3572 | |
3573 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. | |
3574 \outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy} | |
3575 \def\centerchapyyy #1{{\let\unnumbchapmacro=\centerchapmacro \unnumberedyyy{#1}}} | |
3576 | |
3577 % @top is like @unnumbered. | |
3578 \outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} | |
3579 | |
3580 \outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} | |
3581 \def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz | |
3582 \def\unnumberedzzz #1{% | |
3583 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 | |
3584 % | |
3585 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the | |
3586 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX | |
3587 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX | |
3588 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant | |
3589 % to be executed, not expanded). | |
3590 % | |
3591 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear | |
3592 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use | |
3593 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, | |
3594 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for | |
3595 % the toc entries.) | |
3596 \toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}% | |
3597 % | |
3598 \unnumbchapmacro {#1}% | |
3599 \gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3600 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3601 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry{\the\toks0}}}% | |
3602 \temp | |
3603 \unnumbnoderef | |
3604 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec | |
3605 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec | |
3606 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec | |
3607 } | |
3608 | |
3609 % Sections. | |
3610 \outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy} | |
3611 \def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz | |
3612 \def\seczzz #1{% | |
3613 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % | |
3614 \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}% | |
3615 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3616 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3617 {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}}}% | |
3618 \temp | |
3619 \donoderef | |
3620 \nobreak | |
3621 } | |
3622 | |
3623 \outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} | |
3624 \outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} | |
3625 \def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz | |
3626 \def\appendixsectionzzz #1{% | |
3627 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % | |
3628 \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}% | |
3629 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3630 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3631 {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}}}% | |
3632 \temp | |
3633 \appendixnoderef | |
3634 \nobreak | |
3635 } | |
3636 | |
3637 \outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy} | |
3638 \def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz | |
3639 \def\unnumberedseczzz #1{% | |
3640 \plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3641 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3642 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3643 {\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}}}% |
41418 | 3644 \temp |
3645 \unnumbnoderef | |
3646 \nobreak | |
3647 } | |
3648 | |
3649 % Subsections. | |
3650 \outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy} | |
3651 \def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz | |
3652 \def\numberedsubseczzz #1{% | |
3653 \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % | |
3654 \subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% | |
3655 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3656 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3657 {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}% | |
3658 \temp | |
3659 \donoderef | |
3660 \nobreak | |
3661 } | |
3662 | |
3663 \outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy} | |
3664 \def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz | |
3665 \def\appendixsubseczzz #1{% | |
3666 \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % | |
3667 \subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% | |
3668 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3669 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3670 {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}% | |
3671 \temp | |
3672 \appendixnoderef | |
3673 \nobreak | |
3674 } | |
3675 | |
3676 \outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy} | |
3677 \def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz | |
3678 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{% | |
3679 \plainsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3680 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3681 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3682 {\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}}}% |
41418 | 3683 \temp |
3684 \unnumbnoderef | |
3685 \nobreak | |
3686 } | |
3687 | |
3688 % Subsubsections. | |
3689 \outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy} | |
3690 \def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz | |
3691 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{% | |
3692 \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % | |
3693 \subsubsecheading {#1} | |
3694 {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% | |
3695 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3696 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3697 {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}% | |
3698 \temp | |
3699 \donoderef | |
3700 \nobreak | |
3701 } | |
3702 | |
3703 \outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy} | |
3704 \def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz | |
3705 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{% | |
3706 \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % | |
3707 \subsubsecheading {#1} | |
3708 {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% | |
3709 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3710 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}% | |
3711 {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}% | |
3712 \temp | |
3713 \appendixnoderef | |
3714 \nobreak | |
3715 } | |
3716 | |
3717 \outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy} | |
3718 \def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz | |
3719 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{% | |
3720 \plainsubsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% | |
3721 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
3722 \edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3723 {\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}% |
41418 | 3724 \temp |
3725 \unnumbnoderef | |
3726 \nobreak | |
3727 } | |
3728 | |
3729 % These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo. | |
3730 % Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work. | |
3731 \def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} | |
3732 \def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} | |
3733 \def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz} | |
3734 \def\infounnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubseczzz} | |
3735 \def\infounnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubseczzz} | |
3736 | |
3737 \def\infoappendix{\parsearg\appendixzzz} | |
3738 \def\infoappendixsec{\parsearg\appendixseczzz} | |
3739 \def\infoappendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubseczzz} | |
3740 \def\infoappendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubseczzz} | |
3741 | |
3742 \def\infochapter{\parsearg\chapterzzz} | |
3743 \def\infosection{\parsearg\sectionzzz} | |
3744 \def\infosubsection{\parsearg\subsectionzzz} | |
3745 \def\infosubsubsection{\parsearg\subsubsectionzzz} | |
3746 | |
3747 % These macros control what the section commands do, according | |
3748 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). | |
3749 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. | |
3750 \global\let\section = \numberedsec | |
3751 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec | |
3752 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec | |
3753 | |
3754 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading | |
3755 | |
3756 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: | |
3757 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit | |
3758 % overlong headings to fold. | |
3759 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a | |
3760 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. | |
3761 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and | |
3762 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. | |
3763 | |
3764 | |
3765 \def\majorheading{\parsearg\majorheadingzzz} | |
3766 \def\majorheadingzzz #1{% | |
3767 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% | |
3768 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
3769 \parindent=0pt\raggedright | |
3770 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200} | |
3771 | |
3772 \def\chapheading{\parsearg\chapheadingzzz} | |
3773 \def\chapheadingzzz #1{\chapbreak % | |
3774 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
3775 \parindent=0pt\raggedright | |
3776 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200} | |
3777 | |
3778 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. | |
3779 \def\heading{\parsearg\plainsecheading} | |
3780 \def\subheading{\parsearg\plainsubsecheading} | |
3781 \def\subsubheading{\parsearg\plainsubsubsecheading} | |
3782 | |
3783 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only | |
3784 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), | |
3785 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. | |
3786 | |
3787 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) | |
3788 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} | |
3789 | |
3790 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} | |
3791 | |
3792 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it | |
3793 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) | |
3794 | |
3795 \newskip\chapheadingskip | |
3796 | |
3797 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} | |
3798 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} | |
3799 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi} | |
3800 | |
3801 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} | |
3802 | |
3803 \def\CHAPPAGoff{% | |
3804 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
3805 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak | |
3806 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} | |
3807 | |
3808 \def\CHAPPAGon{% | |
3809 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
3810 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager | |
3811 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager | |
3812 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} | |
3813 | |
3814 \def\CHAPPAGodd{ | |
3815 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
3816 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage | |
3817 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage | |
3818 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} | |
3819 | |
3820 \CHAPPAGon | |
3821 | |
3822 \def\CHAPFplain{ | |
3823 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain | |
3824 \global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfplain | |
3825 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfplain} | |
3826 | |
3827 % Plain chapter opening. | |
3828 % #1 is the text, #2 the chapter number or empty if unnumbered. | |
3829 \def\chfplain#1#2{% | |
3830 \pchapsepmacro | |
3831 {% | |
3832 \chapfonts \rm | |
3833 \def\chapnum{#2}% | |
3834 \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\chapnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}% | |
3835 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright | |
3836 \hangindent = \wd0 \centerparametersmaybe | |
3837 \unhbox0 #1\par}% | |
3838 }% | |
3839 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title | |
3840 \nobreak | |
3841 } | |
3842 | |
3843 % Plain opening for unnumbered. | |
3844 \def\unnchfplain#1{\chfplain{#1}{}} | |
3845 | |
3846 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. | |
3847 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax | |
3848 \def\centerchfplain#1{{% | |
3849 \def\centerparametersmaybe{% | |
3850 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip | |
3851 \leftskip = \rightskip | |
3852 \parfillskip = 0pt | |
3853 }% | |
3854 \chfplain{#1}{}% | |
3855 }} | |
3856 | |
3857 \CHAPFplain % The default | |
3858 | |
3859 \def\unnchfopen #1{% | |
3860 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
3861 \parindent=0pt\raggedright | |
3862 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak | |
3863 } | |
3864 | |
3865 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts | |
3866 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% | |
3867 \par\penalty 5000 % | |
3868 } | |
3869 | |
3870 \def\centerchfopen #1{% | |
3871 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
3872 \parindent=0pt | |
3873 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak | |
3874 } | |
3875 | |
3876 \def\CHAPFopen{ | |
3877 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen | |
3878 \global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfopen | |
3879 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} | |
3880 | |
3881 | |
3882 % Section titles. | |
3883 \newskip\secheadingskip | |
3884 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip {-1000}} | |
3885 \def\secheading#1#2#3{\sectionheading{sec}{#2.#3}{#1}} | |
3886 \def\plainsecheading#1{\sectionheading{sec}{}{#1}} | |
3887 | |
3888 % Subsection titles. | |
3889 \newskip \subsecheadingskip | |
3890 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip {-500}} | |
3891 \def\subsecheading#1#2#3#4{\sectionheading{subsec}{#2.#3.#4}{#1}} | |
3892 \def\plainsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsec}{}{#1}} | |
3893 | |
3894 % Subsubsection titles. | |
3895 \let\subsubsecheadingskip = \subsecheadingskip | |
3896 \let\subsubsecheadingbreak = \subsecheadingbreak | |
3897 \def\subsubsecheading#1#2#3#4#5{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{#2.#3.#4.#5}{#1}} | |
3898 \def\plainsubsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{}{#1}} | |
3899 | |
3900 | |
3901 % Print any size section title. | |
3902 % | |
3903 % #1 is the section type (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #2 is the section | |
3904 % number (maybe empty), #3 the text. | |
3905 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3{% | |
3906 {% | |
3907 \expandafter\advance\csname #1headingskip\endcsname by \parskip | |
3908 \csname #1headingbreak\endcsname | |
3909 }% | |
3910 {% | |
3911 % Switch to the right set of fonts. | |
3912 \csname #1fonts\endcsname \rm | |
3913 % | |
3914 % Only insert the separating space if we have a section number. | |
3915 \def\secnum{#2}% | |
3916 \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\secnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}% | |
3917 % | |
3918 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright | |
3919 \hangindent = \wd0 % zero if no section number | |
3920 \unhbox0 #3}% | |
3921 }% | |
3922 \ifdim\parskip<10pt \nobreak\kern10pt\nobreak\kern-\parskip\fi \nobreak | |
3923 } | |
3924 | |
3925 | |
3926 \message{toc,} | |
3927 % Table of contents. | |
3928 \newwrite\tocfile | |
3929 | |
3930 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. | |
3931 % Called from @chapter, etc. We supply {\folio} at the end of the | |
3932 % argument, which will end up as the last argument to the \...entry macro. | |
3933 % | |
3934 % We open the .toc file here instead of at @setfilename or any other | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3935 % fixed time so that @contents can be put in the document anywhere. |
41418 | 3936 % |
3937 \newif\iftocfileopened | |
3938 \def\writetocentry#1{% | |
3939 \iftocfileopened\else | |
3940 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc | |
3941 \global\tocfileopenedtrue | |
3942 \fi | |
3943 \iflinks \write\tocfile{#1{\folio}}\fi | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3944 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3945 % Tell \shipout to create a page destination if we're doing pdf, which |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3946 % will be the target of the links in the table of contents. We can't |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3947 % just do it on every page because the title pages are numbered 1 and |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3948 % 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first two pages |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3949 % of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named `1', and |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3950 % two named `2'. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
3951 \ifpdf \pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi |
41418 | 3952 } |
3953 | |
3954 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in | |
3955 \newcount\savepageno | |
3956 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 | |
3957 | |
3958 % Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written | |
3959 % to \tocfile. | |
3960 % | |
3961 \def\startcontents#1{% | |
3962 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should | |
3963 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain | |
3964 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. | |
3965 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> | |
3966 \contentsalignmacro | |
3967 \immediate\closeout\tocfile | |
3968 % | |
3969 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. | |
3970 % It is abundantly clear what they are. | |
3971 \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}% | |
3972 \savepageno = \pageno | |
3973 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. | |
3974 \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 | |
3975 % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section | |
3976 % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97. | |
3977 %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi | |
3978 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. | |
3979 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. | |
3980 % | |
3981 % Roman numerals for page numbers. | |
3982 \ifnum \pageno>0 \pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi | |
3983 } | |
3984 | |
3985 | |
3986 % Normal (long) toc. | |
3987 \def\contents{% | |
3988 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% | |
3989 \openin 1 \jobname.toc | |
3990 \ifeof 1 \else | |
3991 \closein 1 | |
3992 \input \jobname.toc | |
3993 \fi | |
3994 \vfill \eject | |
3995 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect | |
3996 \pdfmakeoutlines | |
3997 \endgroup | |
3998 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno | |
3999 \pageno = \savepageno | |
4000 } | |
4001 | |
4002 % And just the chapters. | |
4003 \def\summarycontents{% | |
4004 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% | |
4005 % | |
4006 \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4007 \let\appendixentry = \shortappendixentry |
41418 | 4008 \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry |
4009 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. | |
4010 \secfonts | |
4011 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf \let\sl=\shortcontsl | |
4012 \rm | |
4013 \hyphenpenalty = 10000 | |
4014 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. | |
4015 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4016 \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2##3{} |
41418 | 4017 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4018 \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4{} |
41418 | 4019 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4020 \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{} |
41418 | 4021 \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
4022 \ifeof 1 \else | |
4023 \closein 1 | |
4024 \input \jobname.toc | |
4025 \fi | |
4026 \vfill \eject | |
4027 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect | |
4028 \endgroup | |
4029 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno | |
4030 \pageno = \savepageno | |
4031 } | |
4032 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents | |
4033 | |
4034 \ifpdf | |
4035 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% | |
4036 \fi | |
4037 | |
4038 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. | |
4039 % The first argument is the chapter or section name. | |
4040 % The last argument is the page number. | |
4041 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... | |
4042 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4043 % Chapters, in the main contents. |
41418 | 4044 \def\chapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#3}} |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4045 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4046 % Chapters, in the short toc. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4047 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. |
41418 | 4048 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{% |
4049 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#3\egroup}% | |
4050 } | |
4051 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4052 % Appendices, in the main contents. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4053 \def\appendixentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{\putwordAppendix{} #2\labelspace#1}{#3}} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4054 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4055 % Appendices, in the short toc. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4056 \let\shortappendixentry = \shortchapentry |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4057 |
41418 | 4058 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4059 % The arg is, e.g., `Appendix A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. |
41418 | 4060 % We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry |
4061 % command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry | |
4062 % for both, but it doesn't seem worth it. | |
4063 % | |
4064 \newdimen\shortappendixwidth | |
4065 % | |
4066 \def\shortchaplabel#1{% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4067 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the |
41418 | 4068 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4069 % But use \hss just in case. |
41418 | 4070 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after |
4071 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4072 \dimen0 = 1em |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4073 \hbox to \dimen0{#1\hss}% |
41418 | 4074 } |
4075 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4076 % Unnumbered chapters. |
41418 | 4077 \def\unnumbchapentry#1#2{\dochapentry{#1}{#2}} |
4078 \def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#2\egroup}} | |
4079 | |
4080 % Sections. | |
4081 \def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4082 \def\unnumbsecentry#1#2#3{\dosecentry{#1}{#3}} |
41418 | 4083 |
4084 % Subsections. | |
4085 \def\subsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#2.#3.#4\labelspace#1}{#5}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4086 \def\unnumbsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} |
41418 | 4087 |
4088 % And subsubsections. | |
4089 \def\subsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{% | |
4090 \dosubsubsecentry{#2.#3.#4.#5\labelspace#1}{#6}} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4091 \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#5}} |
41418 | 4092 |
4093 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. | |
4094 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 3pc | |
4095 | |
4096 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the | |
4097 % page number. | |
4098 % | |
4099 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters | |
4100 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. | |
4101 \def\dochapentry#1#2{% | |
4102 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip | |
4103 \begingroup | |
4104 \chapentryfonts | |
4105 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
4106 \endgroup | |
4107 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip | |
4108 } | |
4109 | |
4110 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
4111 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent | |
4112 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
4113 \endgroup} | |
4114 | |
4115 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
4116 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent | |
4117 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
4118 \endgroup} | |
4119 | |
4120 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
4121 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent | |
4122 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
4123 \endgroup} | |
4124 | |
4125 % Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for | |
4126 % the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here. (We | |
4127 % can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist | |
4128 % of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.) | |
4129 \def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
4130 \vskip 0pt plus1pt % allow a little stretch for the sake of nice page breaks | |
4131 % Do not use \turnoffactive in these arguments. Since the toc is | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4132 % typeset in cmr, characters such as _ would come out wrong; we |
41418 | 4133 % have to do the usual translation tricks. |
4134 \entry{#1}{#2}% | |
4135 \endgroup} | |
4136 | |
4137 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. | |
4138 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} | |
4139 | |
4140 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} | |
4141 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} | |
4142 | |
4143 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} | |
4144 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} | |
4145 \let\subsecentryfonts = \textfonts | |
4146 \let\subsubsecentryfonts = \textfonts | |
4147 | |
4148 | |
4149 \message{environments,} | |
4150 % @foo ... @end foo. | |
4151 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4152 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4153 % |
41418 | 4154 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of |
4155 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4156 % |
41418 | 4157 \def\point{$\star$} |
4158 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} | |
4159 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} | |
4160 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} | |
4161 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} | |
4162 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4163 % The @error{} command. |
41418 | 4164 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4165 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4166 \newbox\errorbox |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4167 % |
41418 | 4168 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. |
4169 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules | |
4170 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) | |
4171 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4172 % |
41418 | 4173 \global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil |
4174 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. | |
4175 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. | |
4176 \vbox{ | |
4177 \hrule height\dimen2 | |
4178 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. | |
4179 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. | |
4180 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. | |
4181 \hrule height\dimen2} | |
4182 \hfil} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4183 % |
41418 | 4184 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} |
4185 | |
4186 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. | |
4187 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. | |
4188 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. | |
4189 | |
4190 \def\tex{\begingroup | |
4191 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 | |
4192 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 | |
4193 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=13 \let~=\tie | |
4194 \catcode `\%=14 | |
4195 \catcode 43=12 % plus | |
4196 \catcode`\"=12 | |
4197 \catcode`\==12 | |
4198 \catcode`\|=12 | |
4199 \catcode`\<=12 | |
4200 \catcode`\>=12 | |
4201 \escapechar=`\\ | |
4202 % | |
4203 \let\b=\ptexb | |
4204 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet | |
4205 \let\c=\ptexc | |
4206 \let\,=\ptexcomma | |
4207 \let\.=\ptexdot | |
4208 \let\dots=\ptexdots | |
4209 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv | |
4210 \let\!=\ptexexclam | |
4211 \let\i=\ptexi | |
4212 \let\{=\ptexlbrace | |
4213 \let\+=\tabalign | |
4214 \let\}=\ptexrbrace | |
4215 \let\*=\ptexstar | |
4216 \let\t=\ptext | |
4217 % | |
4218 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% | |
4219 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% | |
4220 \def\@{@}% | |
4221 \let\Etex=\endgroup} | |
4222 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4223 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. |
41418 | 4224 % @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things, |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4225 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). |
41418 | 4226 |
4227 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. | |
4228 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in | |
4229 | |
4230 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other | |
4231 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't | |
4232 % have any width. | |
4233 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} | |
4234 | |
4235 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword | |
4236 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this | |
4237 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input | |
4238 % should produce a line of output anyway. | |
4239 % | |
4240 {\obeyspaces % | |
4241 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}} | |
4242 | |
4243 % Define \obeyedspace to be our active space, whatever it is. This is | |
4244 % for use in \parsearg. | |
4245 {\sepspaces% | |
4246 \global\let\obeyedspace= } | |
4247 | |
4248 % This space is always present above and below environments. | |
4249 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt | |
4250 | |
4251 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here | |
4252 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip | |
4253 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the | |
4254 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip | |
4255 % | |
4256 \def\aboveenvbreak{{% | |
4257 \ifnum\lastpenalty < 10000 | |
4258 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip | |
4259 \endgraf | |
4260 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount | |
4261 \removelastskip | |
4262 \penalty-50 | |
4263 \vskip\envskipamount | |
4264 \fi | |
4265 \fi | |
4266 }} | |
4267 | |
4268 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak | |
4269 | |
4270 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. | |
4271 \let\nonarrowing=\relax | |
4272 | |
4273 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around | |
4274 % environment contents. | |
4275 \font\circle=lcircle10 | |
4276 \newdimen\circthick | |
4277 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner | |
4278 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip | |
4279 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle | |
4280 % | |
4281 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth | |
4282 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} | |
4283 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} | |
4284 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} | |
4285 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip | |
4286 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr | |
4287 \hskip\rskip}} | |
4288 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip | |
4289 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr | |
4290 \hskip\rskip}} | |
4291 % | |
4292 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip | |
4293 | |
4294 \long\def\cartouche{% | |
4295 \begingroup | |
4296 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip | |
4297 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*. | |
4298 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip | |
4299 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip | |
4300 \cartouter=\hsize | |
4301 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either | |
4302 % side, and for 6pt waste from | |
4303 % each corner char, and rule thickness | |
4304 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip | |
4305 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. | |
4306 \let\nonarrowing=\comment | |
4307 \vbox\bgroup | |
4308 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt | |
4309 \carttop | |
4310 \hbox\bgroup | |
4311 \hskip\lskip | |
4312 \vrule\kern3pt | |
4313 \vbox\bgroup | |
4314 \hsize=\cartinner | |
4315 \kern3pt | |
4316 \begingroup | |
4317 \baselineskip=\normbskip | |
4318 \lineskip=\normlskip | |
4319 \parskip=\normpskip | |
4320 \vskip -\parskip | |
4321 \def\Ecartouche{% | |
4322 \endgroup | |
4323 \kern3pt | |
4324 \egroup | |
4325 \kern3pt\vrule | |
4326 \hskip\rskip | |
4327 \egroup | |
4328 \cartbot | |
4329 \egroup | |
4330 \endgroup | |
4331 }} | |
4332 | |
4333 | |
4334 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, | |
4335 % inside a group. | |
4336 \def\nonfillstart{% | |
4337 \aboveenvbreak | |
4338 \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body | |
4339 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy | |
4340 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. | |
4341 \singlespace | |
4342 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines | |
4343 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output | |
4344 \parskip = 0pt | |
4345 \parindent = 0pt | |
4346 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes | |
4347 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing | |
4348 % at next level down. | |
4349 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax | |
4350 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing | |
4351 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing | |
4352 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent | |
4353 \let\nonarrowing=\relax | |
4354 \fi | |
4355 } | |
4356 | |
4357 % Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular | |
4358 % environment, so the error checking in \end will work. | |
4359 % | |
4360 % To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via | |
4361 % \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we keep | |
4362 % the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be | |
4363 % inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after | |
4364 % the environment. | |
4365 % | |
4366 \def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup} | |
4367 | |
4368 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font. | |
4369 \def\lisp{\begingroup | |
4370 \nonfillstart | |
4371 \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish | |
4372 \tt | |
4373 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. | |
4374 \gobble % eat return | |
4375 } | |
4376 | |
4377 % @example: Same as @lisp. | |
4378 \def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} | |
4379 | |
4380 % @small... is usually equivalent to the non-small (@smallbook | |
4381 % redefines). We must call \example (or whatever) last in the | |
4382 % definition, since it reads the return following the @example (or | |
4383 % whatever) command. | |
4384 % | |
4385 % This actually allows (for example) @end display inside an | |
4386 % @smalldisplay. Too bad, but makeinfo will catch the error anyway. | |
4387 % | |
4388 \def\smalldisplay{\begingroup\def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\display} | |
4389 \def\smallexample{\begingroup\def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} | |
4390 \def\smallformat{\begingroup\def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} | |
4391 \def\smalllisp{\begingroup\def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} | |
4392 | |
4393 % Real @smallexample and @smalllisp (when @smallbook): use smaller fonts. | |
4394 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. | |
4395 \def\smalllispx{\begingroup | |
4396 \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% | |
4397 \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4398 \smallexamplefonts |
41418 | 4399 \lisp |
4400 } | |
4401 | |
4402 % @display: same as @lisp except keep current font. | |
4403 % | |
4404 \def\display{\begingroup | |
4405 \nonfillstart | |
4406 \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish | |
4407 \gobble | |
4408 } | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4409 % |
41418 | 4410 % @smalldisplay (when @smallbook): @display plus smaller fonts. |
4411 % | |
4412 \def\smalldisplayx{\begingroup | |
4413 \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4414 \smallexamplefonts \rm |
41418 | 4415 \display |
4416 } | |
4417 | |
4418 % @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins. | |
4419 % | |
4420 \def\format{\begingroup | |
4421 \let\nonarrowing = t | |
4422 \nonfillstart | |
4423 \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish | |
4424 \gobble | |
4425 } | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4426 % |
41418 | 4427 % @smallformat (when @smallbook): @format plus smaller fonts. |
4428 % | |
4429 \def\smallformatx{\begingroup | |
4430 \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4431 \smallexamplefonts \rm |
41418 | 4432 \format |
4433 } | |
4434 | |
4435 % @flushleft (same as @format). | |
4436 % | |
4437 \def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} | |
4438 | |
4439 % @flushright. | |
4440 % | |
4441 \def\flushright{\begingroup | |
4442 \let\nonarrowing = t | |
4443 \nonfillstart | |
4444 \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish | |
4445 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill | |
4446 \gobble | |
4447 } | |
4448 | |
4449 | |
4450 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) | |
4451 % and narrows the margins. | |
4452 % | |
4453 \def\quotation{% | |
4454 \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body | |
4455 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip | |
4456 \singlespace | |
4457 \parindent=0pt | |
4458 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're | |
4459 % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment... | |
4460 \def\Equotation{\parskip = 0pt \nonfillfinish}% | |
4461 % | |
4462 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. | |
4463 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax | |
4464 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing | |
4465 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing | |
4466 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing | |
4467 \let\nonarrowing = \relax | |
4468 \fi | |
4469 } | |
4470 | |
4471 | |
4472 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} | |
4473 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, | |
4474 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: | |
4475 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org | |
4476 % | |
4477 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. | |
4478 % | |
4479 % [Knuth] p. 344; only we need to do '@' too | |
4480 \def\dospecials{% | |
4481 \do\ \do\\\do\@\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% | |
4482 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~} | |
4483 % | |
4484 % [Knuth] p. 380 | |
4485 \def\uncatcodespecials{% | |
4486 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=12}\dospecials} | |
4487 % | |
4488 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 | |
4489 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font | |
4490 \begingroup | |
4491 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} | |
4492 \endgroup | |
4493 % | |
4494 % Setup for the @verb command. | |
4495 % | |
4496 % Eight spaces for a tab | |
4497 \begingroup | |
4498 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
4499 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} | |
4500 \endgroup | |
4501 % | |
4502 \def\setupverb{% | |
4503 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim | |
4504 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% | |
4505 \catcode`\`=\active | |
4506 \tabeightspaces | |
4507 % Respect line breaks, | |
4508 % print special symbols as themselves, and | |
4509 % make each space count | |
4510 % must do in this order: | |
4511 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces | |
4512 } | |
4513 | |
4514 % Setup for the @verbatim environment | |
4515 % | |
4516 % Real tab expansion | |
4517 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount | |
4518 % | |
4519 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} | |
4520 \begingroup | |
4521 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
4522 \gdef\tabexpand{% | |
4523 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
4524 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup | |
4525 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab | |
4526 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw | |
4527 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw | |
4528 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw | |
4529 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox | |
4530 }% | |
4531 } | |
4532 \endgroup | |
4533 \def\setupverbatim{% | |
4534 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim | |
4535 \tt | |
4536 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% | |
4537 \catcode`\`=\active | |
4538 \tabexpand | |
4539 % Respect line breaks, | |
4540 % print special symbols as themselves, and | |
4541 % make each space count | |
4542 % must do in this order: | |
4543 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces | |
4544 \everypar{\starttabbox}% | |
4545 } | |
4546 | |
4547 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique | |
4548 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a | |
4549 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: | |
4550 % | |
4551 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} | |
4552 % | |
4553 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} | |
4554 \begingroup | |
4555 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12 | |
4556 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] | |
4557 \endgroup | |
4558 % | |
4559 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} | |
4560 % | |
4561 % | |
4562 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that | |
4563 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: | |
4564 % | |
4565 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} | |
4566 % | |
4567 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, | |
4568 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': | |
4569 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}' | |
4570 % | |
4571 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] | |
4572 %% Include LaTeX hack for completeness -- never know | |
4573 %% \begingroup | |
4574 %% \catcode`|=0 \catcode`[=1 | |
4575 %% \catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12\catcode`\ =\active | |
4576 %% \catcode`\\=12|gdef|doverbatim#1@end verbatim[ | |
4577 %% #1|endgroup|def|Everbatim[]|end[verbatim]] | |
4578 %% |endgroup | |
4579 \begingroup | |
4580 \catcode`\ =\active | |
4581 \gdef\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1\end{verbatim}} | |
4582 \endgroup | |
4583 % | |
4584 \def\verbatim{% | |
4585 \def\Everbatim{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% | |
4586 \begingroup | |
4587 \nonfillstart | |
4588 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent | |
4589 \begingroup\setupverbatim\doverbatim | |
4590 } | |
4591 | |
4592 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. | |
4593 % | |
4594 % Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). | |
4595 \def\verbatiminclude{% | |
4596 \begingroup | |
4597 \catcode`\\=12 | |
4598 \catcode`~=12 | |
4599 \catcode`^=12 | |
4600 \catcode`_=12 | |
4601 \catcode`|=12 | |
4602 \catcode`<=12 | |
4603 \catcode`>=12 | |
4604 \catcode`+=12 | |
4605 \parsearg\doverbatiminclude | |
4606 } | |
4607 \def\setupverbatiminclude{% | |
4608 \begingroup | |
4609 \nonfillstart | |
4610 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent | |
4611 \begingroup\setupverbatim | |
4612 } | |
4613 % | |
4614 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% | |
4615 % Restore active chars for included file. | |
4616 \endgroup | |
4617 \begingroup | |
4618 \def\thisfile{#1}% | |
4619 \expandafter\expandafter\setupverbatiminclude\input\thisfile | |
4620 \endgroup\nonfillfinish\endgroup | |
4621 } | |
4622 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4623 % @copying ... @end copying. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4624 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4625 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4626 \newbox\copyingbox |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4627 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4628 \def\copying{\begingroup |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4629 \parindent = 0pt % looks wrong on title page |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4630 \def\Ecopying{\egroup\endgroup}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4631 \global\setbox\copyingbox = \vbox\bgroup |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4632 } |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4633 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4634 % @insertcopying. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4635 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4636 \def\insertcopying{\unvcopy\copyingbox} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4637 |
41418 | 4638 |
4639 \message{defuns,} | |
4640 % @defun etc. | |
4641 | |
4642 % Allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally | |
4643 \def\setdeffont #1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname} | |
4644 | |
4645 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in | |
4646 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt | |
4647 \newskip\deftypemargin \deftypemargin=12pt | |
4648 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt | |
4649 | |
4650 \newcount\parencount | |
4651 % define \functionparens, which makes ( and ) and & do special things. | |
4652 % \functionparens affects the group it is contained in. | |
4653 \def\activeparens{% | |
4654 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active \catcode`\&=\active | |
4655 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active} | |
4656 | |
4657 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. | |
4658 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) | |
4659 | |
4660 {\activeparens % Now, smart parens don't turn on until &foo (see \amprm) | |
4661 | |
4662 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, | |
4663 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, | |
4664 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. | |
4665 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen | |
4666 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack | |
4667 | |
4668 \gdef\functionparens{\boldbrax\let&=\amprm\parencount=0 } | |
4669 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} | |
4670 % This is used to turn on special parens | |
4671 % but make & act ordinary (given that it's active). | |
4672 \gdef\boldbraxnoamp{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb\let&=\ampnr} | |
4673 | |
4674 % Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions. | |
4675 % This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses. | |
4676 \gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested | |
4677 \global\advance\parencount by 1 | |
4678 } | |
4679 % | |
4680 % This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens. | |
4681 \gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 } | |
4682 % | |
4683 \gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0. | |
4684 % also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (. | |
4685 \ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi | |
4686 \global\advance \parencount by -1 } | |
4687 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards | |
4688 \gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ } | |
4689 % | |
4690 \gdef\normalparens{\boldbrax\let&=\ampnr} | |
4691 } % End of definition inside \activeparens | |
4692 %% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the | |
4693 %% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] | |
4694 \def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 } | |
4695 \def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 } | |
4696 \let\ampnr = \& | |
4697 \def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} | |
4698 \def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}} | |
4699 | |
4700 % Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined. | |
4701 { | |
4702 \catcode`& = 13 | |
4703 \global\let& = \ampnr | |
4704 } | |
4705 | |
4706 % First, defname, which formats the header line itself. | |
4707 % #1 should be the function name. | |
4708 % #2 should be the type of definition, such as "Function". | |
4709 | |
4710 \def\defname #1#2{% | |
4711 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were | |
4712 % outside the @def... | |
4713 \dimen2=\leftskip | |
4714 \advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent | |
4715 \noindent | |
4716 \setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}% | |
4717 \dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line | |
4718 \dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent %size for continuations | |
4719 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 | |
4720 % Now output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) | |
4721 % ending at \deftypemargin from the right margin, | |
4722 % but stuck inside a box of width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking | |
4723 {% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins, | |
4724 % so that \rightline will obey them. | |
4725 \advance \hsize by -\dimen2 | |
4726 \rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip -1.25pc }}}% | |
4727 % Make all lines underfull and no complaints: | |
4728 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 | |
4729 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent | |
4730 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4731 {\df #1}\enskip % Generate function name | |
4732 } | |
4733 | |
4734 % Actually process the body of a definition | |
4735 % #1 should be the terminating control sequence, such as \Edefun. | |
4736 % #2 should be the "another name" control sequence, such as \defunx. | |
4737 % #3 should be the control sequence that actually processes the header, | |
4738 % such as \defunheader. | |
4739 | |
4740 \def\defparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody | |
4741 \medbreak % | |
4742 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4743 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4744 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4745 \def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}% | |
4746 \parindent=0in | |
4747 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4748 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4749 \begingroup % | |
4750 \catcode 61=\active % 61 is `=' | |
4751 \obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3} | |
4752 | |
4753 % #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). | |
4754 % #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define). | |
4755 % #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing. | |
4756 % #4, delimited by the space, is the class name. | |
4757 % | |
4758 \def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV % | |
4759 \medbreak % | |
4760 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4761 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4762 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4763 \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% | |
4764 \parindent=0in | |
4765 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4766 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4767 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}}} | |
4768 | |
4769 % Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar. | |
4770 % #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). | |
4771 % #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define). | |
4772 % #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing. | |
4773 % #4, delimited by a space, is the class name. | |
4774 % #5 is the method's return type. | |
4775 % | |
4776 \def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {\begingroup\inENV | |
4777 \medbreak | |
4778 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4779 \def#2##1 ##2 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}% | |
4780 \parindent=0in | |
4781 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4782 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4783 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}} | |
4784 | |
4785 % Used for @deftypeop. The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an | |
4786 % extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it | |
4787 % being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'. We have | |
4788 % to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the | |
4789 % input at hand. Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for | |
4790 % the \E... definition to assign the category name to. | |
4791 % | |
4792 \def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {\begingroup\inENV | |
4793 \medbreak | |
4794 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4795 \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {% | |
4796 \def#4{##1}% | |
4797 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}% | |
4798 \parindent=0in | |
4799 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4800 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4801 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}} | |
4802 | |
4803 \def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV % | |
4804 \medbreak % | |
4805 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4806 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4807 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4808 \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% | |
4809 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% | |
4810 \parindent=0in | |
4811 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4812 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4813 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} | |
4814 | |
4815 % These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones | |
4816 % except that they do not make parens into active characters. | |
4817 % These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments. | |
4818 | |
4819 \def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody | |
4820 \medbreak % | |
4821 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4822 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4823 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4824 \def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit#3}% | |
4825 \parindent=0in | |
4826 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4827 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4828 \begingroup % | |
4829 \catcode 61=\active % | |
4830 \obeylines\spacesplit#3} | |
4831 | |
4832 % This is used for \def{tp,vr}parsebody. It could probably be used for | |
4833 % some of the others, too, with some judicious conditionals. | |
4834 % | |
4835 \def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{% | |
4836 \begingroup\inENV % | |
4837 \medbreak % | |
4838 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4839 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4840 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4841 \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% | |
4842 \parindent=0in | |
4843 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4844 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4845 \begingroup\obeylines | |
4846 } | |
4847 | |
4848 \def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {% | |
4849 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% | |
4850 \spacesplit{#3{#4}}% | |
4851 } | |
4852 | |
4853 % This loses on `@deftp {Data Type} {struct termios}' -- it thinks the | |
4854 % type is just `struct', because we lose the braces in `{struct | |
4855 % termios}' when \spacesplit reads its undelimited argument. Sigh. | |
4856 % \let\deftpparsebody=\defvrparsebody | |
4857 % | |
4858 % So, to get around this, we put \empty in with the type name. That | |
4859 % way, TeX won't find exactly `{...}' as an undelimited argument, and | |
4860 % won't strip off the braces. | |
4861 % | |
4862 \def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {% | |
4863 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% | |
4864 \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty | |
4865 } | |
4866 | |
4867 % Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the | |
4868 % braces (if any). That's what this does. | |
4869 % | |
4870 \def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{#1} | |
4871 | |
4872 % After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final | |
4873 % thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3 | |
4874 % (which might be empty) the arguments. | |
4875 % | |
4876 \def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{% | |
4877 #1{\removeemptybraces#2\relax}{#3}% | |
4878 }% | |
4879 | |
4880 \def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV % | |
4881 \medbreak % | |
4882 % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies | |
4883 % so that it will exit this group. | |
4884 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% | |
4885 \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% | |
4886 \begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% | |
4887 \parindent=0in | |
4888 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
4889 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
4890 \begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} | |
4891 | |
4892 % Split up #2 at the first space token. | |
4893 % call #1 with two arguments: | |
4894 % the first is all of #2 before the space token, | |
4895 % the second is all of #2 after that space token. | |
4896 % If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg | |
4897 % and the second is passed as empty. | |
4898 | |
4899 {\obeylines | |
4900 \gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitfoo{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitfoo}% | |
4901 \long\gdef\spacesplitfoo#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitfoo{% | |
4902 \ifx\relax #3% | |
4903 #1{#2}{}\else #1{#2}{#3#4}\fi}} | |
4904 | |
4905 % So much for the things common to all kinds of definitions. | |
4906 | |
4907 % Define @defun. | |
4908 | |
4909 % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of \defun | |
4910 % Use this to expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up | |
4911 | |
4912 \def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl | |
4913 % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. | |
4914 % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. | |
4915 % Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro. | |
4916 {\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}% | |
4917 #1% | |
4918 {\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}% | |
4919 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi% | |
4920 \interlinepenalty=10000 | |
4921 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil | |
4922 \endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak | |
4923 } | |
4924 | |
4925 \def\deftypefunargs #1{% | |
4926 % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. | |
4927 % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. | |
4928 % Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special. | |
4929 \boldbraxnoamp | |
4930 \tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars | |
4931 \interlinepenalty=10000 | |
4932 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil | |
4933 \endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak | |
4934 } | |
4935 | |
4936 % Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed. | |
4937 | |
4938 % @deffn Command forward-char nchars | |
4939 | |
4940 \def\deffn{\defmethparsebody\Edeffn\deffnx\deffnheader} | |
4941 | |
4942 \def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% | |
4943 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup % | |
4944 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
4945 } | |
4946 | |
4947 % @defun == @deffn Function | |
4948 | |
4949 \def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader} | |
4950 | |
4951 \def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index | |
4952 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}% | |
4953 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % | |
4954 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
4955 } | |
4956 | |
4957 % @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) | |
4958 | |
4959 \def\deftypefun{\defparsebody\Edeftypefun\deftypefunx\deftypefunheader} | |
4960 | |
4961 % #1 is the data type. #2 is the name and args. | |
4962 \def\deftypefunheader #1#2{\deftypefunheaderx{#1}#2 \relax} | |
4963 % #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args. | |
4964 \def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{% | |
4965 \doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4966 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}% |
41418 | 4967 \deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup % |
4968 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
4969 } | |
4970 | |
4971 % @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) | |
4972 | |
4973 \def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader} | |
4974 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4975 % \defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$ |
41418 | 4976 % puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null. |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4977 \def\defheaderxcond#1#2$.${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi} |
41418 | 4978 |
4979 % #1 is the classification. #2 is the data type. #3 is the name and args. | |
4980 \def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax} | |
4981 % #1 is the classification, #2 the data type, #3 the name, #4 the args. | |
4982 \def\deftypefnheaderx #1#2#3 #4\relax{% | |
4983 \doind {fn}{\code{#3}}% Make entry in function index | |
4984 \begingroup | |
4985 \normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents | |
4986 % at least some C++ text from working | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
4987 \defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1}% |
41418 | 4988 \deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup % |
4989 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
4990 } | |
4991 | |
4992 % @defmac == @deffn Macro | |
4993 | |
4994 \def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader} | |
4995 | |
4996 \def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index | |
4997 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}% | |
4998 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % | |
4999 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
5000 } | |
5001 | |
5002 % @defspec == @deffn Special Form | |
5003 | |
5004 \def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader} | |
5005 | |
5006 \def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index | |
5007 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}% | |
5008 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % | |
5009 \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody | |
5010 } | |
5011 | |
5012 % @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG... | |
5013 % | |
5014 \def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}% | |
5015 \defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype} | |
5016 % | |
5017 \def\defopheader#1#2#3{% | |
5018 \dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ #1}% Make entry in function index | |
5019 \begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}% | |
5020 \defunargs {#3}\endgroup % | |
5021 } | |
5022 | |
5023 % @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG... | |
5024 % | |
5025 \def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}% | |
5026 \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader | |
5027 \deftypeopcategory} | |
5028 % | |
5029 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args. | |
5030 \def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{% | |
5031 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index | |
5032 \begingroup | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5033 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} |
41418 | 5034 {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}% |
5035 \deftypefunargs{#4}% | |
5036 \endgroup | |
5037 } | |
5038 | |
5039 % @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG... | |
5040 % | |
5041 \def\deftypemethod{% | |
5042 \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader} | |
5043 % | |
5044 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args. | |
5045 \def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{% | |
5046 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index | |
5047 \begingroup | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5048 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% |
41418 | 5049 \deftypefunargs{#4}% |
5050 \endgroup | |
5051 } | |
5052 | |
5053 % @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME | |
5054 % | |
5055 \def\deftypeivar{% | |
5056 \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader} | |
5057 % | |
5058 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name. | |
5059 \def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{% | |
5060 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index | |
5061 \begingroup | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5062 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} |
41418 | 5063 {\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}% |
5064 \defvarargs{#3}% | |
5065 \endgroup | |
5066 } | |
5067 | |
5068 % @defmethod == @defop Method | |
5069 % | |
5070 \def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader} | |
5071 % | |
5072 % #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args. | |
5073 \def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{% | |
5074 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index | |
5075 \begingroup | |
5076 \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% | |
5077 \defunargs{#3}% | |
5078 \endgroup | |
5079 } | |
5080 | |
5081 % @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag | |
5082 | |
5083 \def\defcv #1 {\def\defcvtype{#1}% | |
5084 \defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype} | |
5085 | |
5086 \def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{% | |
5087 \dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% Make entry in var index | |
5088 \begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}% | |
5089 \defvarargs {#3}\endgroup % | |
5090 } | |
5091 | |
5092 % @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME | |
5093 % | |
5094 \def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader} | |
5095 % | |
5096 \def\defivarheader#1#2#3{% | |
5097 \dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% entry in var index | |
5098 \begingroup | |
5099 \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}% | |
5100 \defvarargs{#3}% | |
5101 \endgroup | |
5102 } | |
5103 | |
5104 % @defvar | |
5105 % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar. | |
5106 % This is actually simple: just print them in roman. | |
5107 % This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up | |
5108 \def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1% | |
5109 \interlinepenalty=10000 | |
5110 \endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak} | |
5111 | |
5112 % @defvr Counter foo-count | |
5113 | |
5114 \def\defvr{\defvrparsebody\Edefvr\defvrx\defvrheader} | |
5115 | |
5116 \def\defvrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}% | |
5117 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defvarargs{#3}\endgroup} | |
5118 | |
5119 % @defvar == @defvr Variable | |
5120 | |
5121 \def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader} | |
5122 | |
5123 \def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index | |
5124 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}% | |
5125 \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % | |
5126 } | |
5127 | |
5128 % @defopt == @defvr {User Option} | |
5129 | |
5130 \def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader} | |
5131 | |
5132 \def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index | |
5133 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}% | |
5134 \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % | |
5135 } | |
5136 | |
5137 % @deftypevar int foobar | |
5138 | |
5139 \def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader} | |
5140 | |
5141 % #1 is the data type. #2 is the name, perhaps followed by text that | |
5142 % is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index. | |
5143 \def\deftypevarheader #1#2{% | |
5144 \dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5145 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}% |
41418 | 5146 \interlinepenalty=10000 |
5147 \endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak | |
5148 \endgroup} | |
5149 \def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}} | |
5150 | |
5151 % @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable | |
5152 | |
5153 \def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader} | |
5154 | |
5155 \def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5156 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1} |
41418 | 5157 \interlinepenalty=10000 |
5158 \endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak | |
5159 \endgroup} | |
5160 | |
5161 % Now define @deftp | |
5162 % Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar. | |
5163 | |
5164 \def\deftpargs #1{\bf \defvarargs{#1}} | |
5165 | |
5166 % @deftp Class window height width ... | |
5167 | |
5168 \def\deftp{\deftpparsebody\Edeftp\deftpx\deftpheader} | |
5169 | |
5170 \def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}% | |
5171 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup} | |
5172 | |
5173 % These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.) | |
5174 % anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. | |
5175 % | |
5176 \def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} | |
5177 \def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} | |
5178 \def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} | |
5179 \def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} | |
5180 \def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} | |
5181 \def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} | |
5182 \def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} | |
5183 \def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} | |
5184 \def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} | |
5185 \def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} | |
5186 \def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefunx in invalid context}} | |
5187 \def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeivarx in invalid context}} | |
5188 \def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}} | |
5189 \def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeopx in invalid context}} | |
5190 \def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} | |
5191 \def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} | |
5192 \def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} | |
5193 \def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} | |
5194 \def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} | |
5195 | |
5196 | |
5197 \message{macros,} | |
5198 % @macro. | |
5199 | |
5200 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, | |
5201 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. | |
5202 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined | |
5203 \newwrite\macscribble | |
5204 \def\scanmacro#1{% | |
5205 \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M | |
5206 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex | |
5207 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@ | |
5208 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. | |
5209 \toks0={#1\endinput}% | |
5210 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp | |
5211 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% | |
5212 \immediate\closeout\macscribble | |
5213 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces | |
5214 \input \jobname.tmp | |
5215 \endgroup | |
5216 } | |
5217 \else | |
5218 \def\scanmacro#1{% | |
5219 \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M | |
5220 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex | |
5221 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@ | |
5222 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup} | |
5223 \fi | |
5224 | |
5225 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters | |
5226 \newtoks\macname % Macro name | |
5227 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? | |
5228 \def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form | |
5229 % \do\macro1\do\macro2... | |
5230 | |
5231 % Utility routines. | |
5232 % Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames. | |
5233 \def\cslet#1#2{% | |
5234 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5235 \expandafter\let | |
5236 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5237 \csname#1\endcsname | |
5238 \csname#2\endcsname} | |
5239 | |
5240 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. | |
5241 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). | |
5242 {\catcode`\@=11 | |
5243 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} | |
5244 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} | |
5245 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} | |
5246 \def\unbrace#1{#1} | |
5247 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} | |
5248 } | |
5249 | |
5250 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. | |
5251 {\catcode`\^^M=12\catcode`\Q=3% | |
5252 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% | |
5253 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% | |
5254 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% | |
5255 } | |
5256 | |
5257 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where | |
5258 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active | |
5259 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. | |
5260 | |
5261 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is | |
5262 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro | |
5263 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. | |
5264 | |
5265 \def\macrobodyctxt{% | |
5266 \catcode`\~=12 | |
5267 \catcode`\^=12 | |
5268 \catcode`\_=12 | |
5269 \catcode`\|=12 | |
5270 \catcode`\<=12 | |
5271 \catcode`\>=12 | |
5272 \catcode`\+=12 | |
5273 \catcode`\{=12 | |
5274 \catcode`\}=12 | |
5275 \catcode`\@=12 | |
5276 \catcode`\^^M=12 | |
5277 \usembodybackslash} | |
5278 | |
5279 \def\macroargctxt{% | |
5280 \catcode`\~=12 | |
5281 \catcode`\^=12 | |
5282 \catcode`\_=12 | |
5283 \catcode`\|=12 | |
5284 \catcode`\<=12 | |
5285 \catcode`\>=12 | |
5286 \catcode`\+=12 | |
5287 \catcode`\@=12 | |
5288 \catcode`\\=12} | |
5289 | |
5290 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. | |
5291 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N | |
5292 % where N is the macro parameter number. | |
5293 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so | |
5294 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. | |
5295 | |
5296 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active | |
5297 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} | |
5298 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} | |
5299 } | |
5300 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} | |
5301 | |
5302 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} | |
5303 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} | |
5304 | |
5305 \def\macroxxx#1{% | |
5306 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist | |
5307 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments | |
5308 \paramno=0% | |
5309 \else | |
5310 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% | |
5311 \fi | |
5312 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname | |
5313 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% | |
5314 \else | |
5315 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5316 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi |
41418 | 5317 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% |
5318 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% | |
5319 % Add the macroname to \macrolist | |
5320 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% | |
5321 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 | |
5322 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% | |
5323 \fi | |
5324 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt | |
5325 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody | |
5326 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody | |
5327 \fi} | |
5328 | |
5329 \def\unmacro{\parsearg\unmacroxxx} | |
5330 \def\unmacroxxx#1{% | |
5331 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname | |
5332 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% | |
5333 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% | |
5334 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist | |
5335 \begingroup | |
5336 \edef\tempa{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}% | |
5337 \def\do##1{% | |
5338 \def\tempb{##1}% | |
5339 \ifx\tempa\tempb | |
5340 % remove this | |
5341 \else | |
5342 \toks0 = \expandafter{\newmacrolist\do}% | |
5343 \edef\newmacrolist{\the\toks0\expandafter\noexpand\tempa}% | |
5344 \fi}% | |
5345 \def\newmacrolist{}% | |
5346 % Execute macro list to define \newmacrolist | |
5347 \macrolist | |
5348 \global\let\macrolist\newmacrolist | |
5349 \endgroup | |
5350 \else | |
5351 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% | |
5352 \fi | |
5353 } | |
5354 | |
5355 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a | |
5356 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by | |
5357 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. | |
5358 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} | |
5359 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} | |
5360 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} | |
5361 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} | |
5362 | |
5363 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist | |
5364 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah | |
5365 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. | |
5366 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). | |
5367 | |
5368 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. | |
5369 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something | |
5370 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine | |
5371 % it to # just before using the token list produced. | |
5372 % | |
5373 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before | |
5374 % the macro is used. | |
5375 | |
5376 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% | |
5377 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} | |
5378 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% | |
5379 \if#1;\let\next=\relax | |
5380 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx | |
5381 \advance\paramno by 1% | |
5382 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname | |
5383 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% | |
5384 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% | |
5385 \fi\next} | |
5386 | |
5387 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. | |
5388 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) | |
5389 | |
5390 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% | |
5391 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% | |
5392 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% | |
5393 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% | |
5394 | |
5395 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and | |
5396 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. | |
5397 % Much magic with \expandafter here. | |
5398 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file | |
5399 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. | |
5400 \def\defmacro{% | |
5401 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars | |
5402 \ifrecursive | |
5403 \ifcase\paramno | |
5404 % 0 | |
5405 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5406 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
5407 \or % 1 | |
5408 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5409 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
5410 \noexpand\braceorline | |
5411 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% | |
5412 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% | |
5413 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
5414 \else % many | |
5415 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5416 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
5417 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% | |
5418 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% | |
5419 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% | |
5420 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5421 \expandafter\xdef | |
5422 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5423 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname | |
5424 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
5425 \fi | |
5426 \else | |
5427 \ifcase\paramno | |
5428 % 0 | |
5429 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5430 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
5431 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
5432 \or % 1 | |
5433 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5434 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
5435 \noexpand\braceorline | |
5436 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% | |
5437 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% | |
5438 \egroup | |
5439 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
5440 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
5441 \else % many | |
5442 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
5443 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
5444 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% | |
5445 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% | |
5446 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% | |
5447 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5448 \expandafter\xdef | |
5449 \expandafter\expandafter | |
5450 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname | |
5451 \paramlist{% | |
5452 \egroup | |
5453 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
5454 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
5455 \fi | |
5456 \fi} | |
5457 | |
5458 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} | |
5459 | |
5460 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a | |
5461 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole | |
5462 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence | |
5463 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) | |
5464 \def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} | |
5465 \def\braceorlinexxx{% | |
5466 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else | |
5467 \expandafter\parsearg | |
5468 \fi \next} | |
5469 | |
5470 % We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not | |
5471 % expanded by \write. | |
5472 \def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% | |
5473 \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} | |
5474 | |
5475 | |
5476 % @alias. | |
5477 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal | |
5478 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. | |
5479 \def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx} | |
5480 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} | |
5481 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces | |
5482 \edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=% | |
5483 \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}% | |
5484 \expandafter\endgroup\next} | |
5485 | |
5486 | |
5487 \message{cross references,} | |
5488 % @xref etc. | |
5489 | |
5490 \newwrite\auxfile | |
5491 | |
5492 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. | |
5493 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. | |
5494 | |
5495 % @inforef is relatively simple. | |
5496 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} | |
5497 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, | |
5498 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} | |
5499 | |
5500 % @node's job is to define \lastnode. | |
5501 \def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} | |
5502 \def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]} | |
5503 \def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} | |
5504 \let\nwnode=\node | |
5505 \let\lastnode=\relax | |
5506 | |
5507 % The sectioning commands (@chapter, etc.) call these. | |
5508 \def\donoderef{% | |
5509 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else | |
5510 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% | |
5511 {Ysectionnumberandtype}% | |
5512 \global\let\lastnode=\relax | |
5513 \fi | |
5514 } | |
5515 \def\unnumbnoderef{% | |
5516 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else | |
5517 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{Ynothing}% | |
5518 \global\let\lastnode=\relax | |
5519 \fi | |
5520 } | |
5521 \def\appendixnoderef{% | |
5522 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else | |
5523 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% | |
5524 {Yappendixletterandtype}% | |
5525 \global\let\lastnode=\relax | |
5526 \fi | |
5527 } | |
5528 | |
5529 | |
5530 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. | |
5531 % | |
5532 \newcount\savesfregister | |
5533 \gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} | |
5534 \gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} | |
5535 \gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} | |
5536 | |
5537 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME, namely | |
5538 % NAME-title, NAME-pg, and NAME-SNT. Called from \foonoderef. We have | |
5539 % to set \indexdummies so commands such as @code in a section title | |
5540 % aren't expanded. It would be nicer not to expand the titles in the | |
5541 % first place, but there's so many layers that that is hard to do. | |
5542 % | |
5543 \def\setref#1#2{{% | |
5544 \indexdummies | |
5545 \pdfmkdest{#1}% | |
5546 \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% | |
5547 \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% | |
5548 \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}% | |
5549 }} | |
5550 | |
5551 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is | |
5552 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed | |
5553 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed | |
5554 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. | |
5555 % | |
5556 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
5557 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
5558 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
5559 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup | |
5560 \unsepspaces | |
5561 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% | |
5562 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
5563 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}% | |
5564 \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}% | |
5565 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt | |
5566 % No printed node name was explicitly given. | |
5567 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax | |
5568 % Use the node name inside the square brackets. | |
5569 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
5570 \else | |
5571 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside | |
5572 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. | |
5573 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt | |
5574 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. | |
5575 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
5576 \else | |
5577 \ifhavexrefs | |
5578 % We know the real title if we have the xref values. | |
5579 \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}{}}% | |
5580 \else | |
5581 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. | |
5582 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
5583 \fi% | |
5584 \fi | |
5585 \fi | |
5586 \fi | |
5587 % | |
5588 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not | |
5589 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will | |
5590 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals | |
5591 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this | |
5592 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it | |
5593 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. | |
5594 \ifpdf | |
5595 \leavevmode | |
5596 \getfilename{#4}% | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5597 {\normalturnoffactive |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5598 \ifnum\filenamelength>0 |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5599 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5600 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5601 \else |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5602 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5603 goto name{#1}% |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5604 \fi |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5605 }% |
41418 | 5606 \linkcolor |
5607 \fi | |
5608 % | |
5609 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt | |
5610 \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% | |
5611 \else | |
5612 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the | |
5613 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand | |
5614 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of | |
5615 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the | |
5616 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. | |
5617 {\normalturnoffactive | |
5618 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for | |
5619 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. | |
5620 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% | |
5621 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi | |
5622 }% | |
5623 % [mynode], | |
5624 [\printednodename],\space | |
5625 % page 3 | |
5626 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% | |
5627 \fi | |
5628 \endlink | |
5629 \endgroup} | |
5630 | |
5631 % \dosetq is the interface for calls from other macros | |
5632 | |
5633 % Use \normalturnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore | |
5634 % and backslash work in node names. (\turnoffactive doesn't do \.) | |
5635 \def\dosetq#1#2{% | |
5636 {\let\folio=0% | |
5637 \normalturnoffactive | |
5638 \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}% | |
5639 \iflinks | |
5640 \next | |
5641 \fi | |
5642 }% | |
5643 } | |
5644 | |
5645 % \internalsetq {foo}{page} expands into | |
5646 % CHARACTERS 'xrdef {foo}{...expansion of \Ypage...} | |
5647 % When the aux file is read, ' is the escape character | |
5648 | |
5649 \def\internalsetq #1#2{'xrdef {#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}} | |
5650 | |
5651 % Things to be expanded by \internalsetq | |
5652 | |
5653 \def\Ypagenumber{\folio} | |
5654 | |
5655 \def\Ytitle{\thissection} | |
5656 | |
5657 \def\Ynothing{} | |
5658 | |
5659 \def\Ysectionnumberandtype{% | |
5660 \ifnum\secno=0 \putwordChapter\xreftie\the\chapno % | |
5661 \else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno % | |
5662 \else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 % | |
5663 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno % | |
5664 \else % | |
5665 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno % | |
5666 \fi \fi \fi } | |
5667 | |
5668 \def\Yappendixletterandtype{% | |
5669 \ifnum\secno=0 \putwordAppendix\xreftie'char\the\appendixno{}% | |
5670 \else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno % | |
5671 \else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 % | |
5672 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno % | |
5673 \else % | |
5674 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno % | |
5675 \fi \fi \fi } | |
5676 | |
5677 \gdef\xreftie{'tie} | |
5678 | |
5679 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error | |
5680 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. | |
5681 % | |
5682 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined | |
5683 \let\linenumber = \empty % Non-3.0. | |
5684 \else | |
5685 \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space} | |
5686 \fi | |
5687 | |
5688 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. | |
5689 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. | |
5690 | |
5691 \def\refx#1#2{% | |
5692 \expandafter\ifx\csname X#1\endcsname\relax | |
5693 % If not defined, say something at least. | |
5694 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright | |
5695 \iflinks | |
5696 \ifhavexrefs | |
5697 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% | |
5698 \else | |
5699 \ifwarnedxrefs\else | |
5700 \global\warnedxrefstrue | |
5701 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% | |
5702 \fi | |
5703 \fi | |
5704 \fi | |
5705 \else | |
5706 % It's defined, so just use it. | |
5707 \csname X#1\endcsname | |
5708 \fi | |
5709 #2% Output the suffix in any case. | |
5710 } | |
5711 | |
5712 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. | |
5713 % | |
5714 \def\xrdef#1{\begingroup | |
5715 % Reenable \ as an escape while reading the second argument. | |
5716 \catcode`\\ = 0 | |
5717 \afterassignment\endgroup | |
5718 \expandafter\gdef\csname X#1\endcsname | |
5719 } | |
5720 | |
5721 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. | |
5722 \def\readauxfile{\begingroup | |
5723 \catcode`\^^@=\other | |
5724 \catcode`\^^A=\other | |
5725 \catcode`\^^B=\other | |
5726 \catcode`\^^C=\other | |
5727 \catcode`\^^D=\other | |
5728 \catcode`\^^E=\other | |
5729 \catcode`\^^F=\other | |
5730 \catcode`\^^G=\other | |
5731 \catcode`\^^H=\other | |
5732 \catcode`\^^K=\other | |
5733 \catcode`\^^L=\other | |
5734 \catcode`\^^N=\other | |
5735 \catcode`\^^P=\other | |
5736 \catcode`\^^Q=\other | |
5737 \catcode`\^^R=\other | |
5738 \catcode`\^^S=\other | |
5739 \catcode`\^^T=\other | |
5740 \catcode`\^^U=\other | |
5741 \catcode`\^^V=\other | |
5742 \catcode`\^^W=\other | |
5743 \catcode`\^^X=\other | |
5744 \catcode`\^^Z=\other | |
5745 \catcode`\^^[=\other | |
5746 \catcode`\^^\=\other | |
5747 \catcode`\^^]=\other | |
5748 \catcode`\^^^=\other | |
5749 \catcode`\^^_=\other | |
5750 \catcode`\@=\other | |
5751 \catcode`\^=\other | |
5752 % It was suggested to define this as 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. | |
5753 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't | |
5754 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, | |
5755 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ | |
5756 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat | |
5757 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first | |
5758 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could | |
5759 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. | |
5760 % | |
5761 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: | |
5762 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter | |
5763 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. | |
5764 % | |
5765 \catcode`\~=\other | |
5766 \catcode`\[=\other | |
5767 \catcode`\]=\other | |
5768 \catcode`\"=\other | |
5769 \catcode`\_=\other | |
5770 \catcode`\|=\other | |
5771 \catcode`\<=\other | |
5772 \catcode`\>=\other | |
5773 \catcode`\$=\other | |
5774 \catcode`\#=\other | |
5775 \catcode`\&=\other | |
5776 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off | |
5777 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters | |
5778 {% | |
5779 \count 1=128 | |
5780 \def\loop{% | |
5781 \catcode\count 1=\other | |
5782 \advance\count 1 by 1 | |
5783 \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi | |
5784 }% | |
5785 }% | |
5786 % The aux file uses ' as the escape (for now). | |
5787 % Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on | |
5788 % entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names. | |
5789 % For example, 'xrdef {$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^ | |
5790 % Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish, | |
5791 % but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in. | |
5792 \catcode`\{=1 | |
5793 \catcode`\}=2 | |
5794 \catcode`\%=\other | |
5795 \catcode`\'=0 | |
5796 \catcode`\\=\other | |
5797 % | |
5798 \openin 1 \jobname.aux | |
5799 \ifeof 1 \else | |
5800 \closein 1 | |
5801 \input \jobname.aux | |
5802 \global\havexrefstrue | |
5803 \global\warnedobstrue | |
5804 \fi | |
5805 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. | |
5806 \openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux | |
5807 \endgroup} | |
5808 | |
5809 | |
5810 % Footnotes. | |
5811 | |
5812 \newcount \footnoteno | |
5813 | |
5814 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is | |
5815 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a | |
5816 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is | |
5817 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a | |
5818 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) | |
5819 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } | |
5820 | |
5821 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. | |
5822 \let\footnotestyle=\comment | |
5823 | |
5824 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote | |
5825 | |
5826 {\catcode `\@=11 | |
5827 % | |
5828 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. | |
5829 \gdef\footnote{% | |
5830 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne | |
5831 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% | |
5832 % | |
5833 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the | |
5834 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. | |
5835 \let\@sf\empty | |
5836 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\/\fi | |
5837 % | |
5838 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. | |
5839 \unskip | |
5840 \thisfootno\@sf | |
5841 \footnotezzz | |
5842 }% | |
5843 | |
5844 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the | |
5845 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. | |
5846 % | |
5847 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset and anything else that uses | |
5848 % \parseargline fail inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when | |
5849 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. | |
5850 % | |
5851 \long\gdef\footnotezzz{\insert\footins\bgroup | |
5852 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the | |
5853 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. | |
5854 % So reset some parameters. | |
5855 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty | |
5856 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes | |
5857 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox | |
5858 \floatingpenalty\@MM | |
5859 \leftskip\z@skip | |
5860 \rightskip\z@skip | |
5861 \spaceskip\z@skip | |
5862 \xspaceskip\z@skip | |
5863 \parindent\defaultparindent | |
5864 % | |
5865 \smallfonts \rm | |
5866 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5867 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5868 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5869 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5870 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5871 \let\noindent = \relax |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5872 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5873 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5874 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5875 \everypar = {\hang}% |
41418 | 5876 \textindent{\thisfootno}% |
5877 % | |
5878 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this | |
5879 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it | |
5880 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. | |
5881 \footstrut | |
5882 \futurelet\next\fo@t | |
5883 } | |
5884 \def\fo@t{\ifcat\bgroup\noexpand\next \let\next\f@@t | |
5885 \else\let\next\f@t\fi \next} | |
5886 \def\f@@t{\bgroup\aftergroup\@foot\let\next} | |
5887 \def\f@t#1{#1\@foot} | |
5888 \def\@foot{\strut\par\egroup} | |
5889 | |
5890 }%end \catcode `\@=11 | |
5891 | |
5892 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should | |
5893 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the | |
5894 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would | |
5895 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main | |
5896 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). | |
5897 % | |
5898 \def\|{% | |
5899 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. | |
5900 \leavevmode | |
5901 % | |
5902 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. | |
5903 \vadjust{% | |
5904 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current | |
5905 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. | |
5906 \vskip-\baselineskip | |
5907 % | |
5908 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So | |
5909 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. | |
5910 \llap{% | |
5911 % | |
5912 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. | |
5913 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt | |
5914 % | |
5915 % This is the space between the bar and the text. | |
5916 \hskip 12pt | |
5917 }% | |
5918 }% | |
5919 } | |
5920 | |
5921 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles | |
5922 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided | |
5923 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). | |
5924 % | |
5925 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} | |
5926 | |
5927 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. | |
5928 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. | |
5929 % | |
5930 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image | |
5931 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get | |
5932 % undone and the next image would fail. | |
5933 \openin 1 = epsf.tex | |
5934 \ifeof 1 \else | |
5935 \closein 1 | |
5936 % Do not bother showing banner with post-v2.7 epsf.tex (available in | |
5937 % doc/epsf.tex until it shows up on ctan). | |
5938 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% | |
5939 \input epsf.tex | |
5940 \fi | |
5941 % | |
5942 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. | |
5943 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf | |
5944 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to | |
5945 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get | |
5946 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} | |
5947 % | |
5948 \def\image#1{% | |
5949 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined | |
5950 \ifwarnednoepsf \else | |
5951 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp | |
5952 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% | |
5953 \global\warnednoepsftrue | |
5954 \fi | |
5955 \else | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5956 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish |
41418 | 5957 \fi |
5958 } | |
5959 % | |
5960 % Arguments to @image: | |
5961 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. | |
5962 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5963 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5964 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5965 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5966 \newif\ifimagevmode |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5967 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5968 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5969 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5970 % If the image is by itself, center it. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5971 \ifvmode |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5972 \imagevmodetrue |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5973 \nobreak\bigskip |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5974 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5975 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5976 % above and below. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5977 \nobreak\vskip\parskip |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5978 \nobreak |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5979 \line\bgroup\hss |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5980 \fi |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5981 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5982 % Output the image. |
41418 | 5983 \ifpdf |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5984 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
41418 | 5985 \else |
5986 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. | |
5987 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi | |
5988 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5989 \epsfbox{#1.eps}% |
41418 | 5990 \fi |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5991 % |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5992 \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
5993 \endgroup} |
41418 | 5994 |
5995 | |
5996 \message{localization,} | |
5997 % and i18n. | |
5998 | |
5999 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after | |
6000 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything | |
6001 % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. | |
6002 % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. | |
6003 % | |
6004 \def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage} | |
6005 \def\dodocumentlanguage#1{% | |
6006 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. | |
6007 % Read the file if it exists. | |
6008 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex | |
6009 \ifeof1 | |
6010 \errhelp = \nolanghelp | |
6011 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% | |
6012 \let\temp = \relax | |
6013 \else | |
6014 \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }% | |
6015 \fi | |
6016 \temp | |
6017 \endgroup | |
6018 } | |
6019 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or | |
6020 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory | |
6021 should work if nowhere else does.} | |
6022 | |
6023 | |
6024 % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most | |
6025 % likely, but for now just recognize it. | |
6026 \let\documentencoding = \comment | |
6027 | |
6028 | |
6029 % Page size parameters. | |
6030 % | |
6031 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt | |
6032 | |
6033 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt | |
6034 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt | |
6035 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt | |
6036 | |
6037 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. | |
6038 \vbadness = 10000 | |
6039 | |
6040 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. | |
6041 \hbadness = 2000 | |
6042 | |
6043 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. | |
6044 \widowpenalty=10000 | |
6045 \clubpenalty=10000 | |
6046 | |
6047 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're | |
6048 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of | |
6049 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on | |
6050 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. | |
6051 % | |
6052 \def\setemergencystretch{% | |
6053 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined | |
6054 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. | |
6055 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% | |
6056 \else | |
6057 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize | |
6058 \fi | |
6059 } | |
6060 | |
6061 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6062 % 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip. We also call |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6063 % \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define \textleading. |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6064 % The caller should also set \parskip. |
41418 | 6065 % |
6066 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6{% | |
6067 \voffset = #3\relax | |
6068 \topskip = #6\relax | |
6069 \splittopskip = \topskip | |
6070 % | |
6071 \vsize = #1\relax | |
6072 \advance\vsize by \topskip | |
6073 \outervsize = \vsize | |
6074 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin | |
6075 \pageheight = \vsize | |
6076 % | |
6077 \hsize = #2\relax | |
6078 \outerhsize = \hsize | |
6079 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in | |
6080 \pagewidth = \hsize | |
6081 % | |
6082 \normaloffset = #4\relax | |
6083 \bindingoffset = #5\relax | |
6084 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6085 \setleading{\textleading} |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6086 % |
41418 | 6087 \parindent = \defaultparindent |
6088 \setemergencystretch | |
6089 } | |
6090 | |
6091 % Use `small' versions. | |
6092 % | |
6093 \def\smallenvironments{% | |
6094 \let\smalldisplay = \smalldisplayx | |
6095 \let\smallexample = \smalllispx | |
6096 \let\smallformat = \smallformatx | |
6097 \let\smalllisp = \smalllispx | |
6098 } | |
6099 | |
6100 % @letterpaper (the default). | |
6101 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
6102 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6103 \textleading = 13.2pt |
41418 | 6104 % |
6105 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. | |
6106 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{36pt}% | |
6107 }} | |
6108 | |
6109 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. | |
6110 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
6111 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6112 \textleading = 12pt |
41418 | 6113 % |
6114 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5.in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{16pt}% | |
6115 % | |
6116 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in | |
6117 \tolerance = 700 | |
6118 \hfuzz = 1pt | |
6119 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt | |
6120 \deftypemargin = 0pt | |
6121 \defbodyindent = .5cm | |
6122 \smallenvironments | |
6123 }} | |
6124 | |
6125 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. | |
6126 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
6127 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6128 \textleading = 12pt |
41418 | 6129 % |
6130 \internalpagesizes{53\baselineskip}{160mm}{\voffset}{4mm}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}% | |
6131 % | |
6132 \tolerance = 700 | |
6133 \hfuzz = 1pt | |
6134 }} | |
6135 | |
6136 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. | |
6137 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. | |
6138 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. | |
6139 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
6140 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6141 \textleading = 12.5pt |
41418 | 6142 % |
6143 \internalpagesizes{166mm}{120mm}{\voffset}{-8mm}{\bindingoffset}{8pt}% | |
6144 % | |
6145 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in | |
6146 \tolerance = 800 | |
6147 \hfuzz = 1.2pt | |
6148 \contentsrightmargin = 0mm | |
6149 \deftypemargin = 0pt | |
6150 \defbodyindent = 2mm | |
6151 \tableindent = 12mm | |
6152 % | |
6153 \smallenvironments | |
6154 }} | |
6155 | |
6156 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. Top margin | |
6157 % 29mm, hence bottom margin 28mm, nominal side margin 3cm. | |
6158 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6159 \textleading = 13.6pt |
41418 | 6160 % |
6161 \afourpaper | |
6162 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}{3.6mm}{3.6mm}{3mm}{7mm}% | |
6163 % | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6164 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper, apparently, |
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6165 % although this does not entirely make sense. |
41418 | 6166 \globaldefs = 0 |
6167 }} | |
6168 | |
6169 % Use @afourwide to print on European A4 paper in wide format. | |
6170 \def\afourwide{% | |
6171 \afourpaper | |
6172 \internalpagesizes{6.5in}{9.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{7mm}% | |
6173 } | |
6174 | |
6175 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] | |
6176 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, | |
6177 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. | |
6178 % | |
6179 \def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx} | |
6180 \def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} | |
6181 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% | |
6182 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi | |
6183 \globaldefs = 1 | |
6184 % | |
6185 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6186 \setleading{\textleading}% |
41418 | 6187 % |
6188 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}{\voffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}% | |
6189 }} | |
6190 | |
6191 % Set default to letter. | |
6192 % | |
6193 \letterpaper | |
6194 | |
6195 | |
6196 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} | |
6197 | |
6198 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. | |
6199 \catcode`\"=\other | |
6200 \catcode`\~=\other | |
6201 \catcode`\^=\other | |
6202 \catcode`\_=\other | |
6203 \catcode`\|=\other | |
6204 \catcode`\<=\other | |
6205 \catcode`\>=\other | |
6206 \catcode`\+=\other | |
6207 \catcode`\$=\other | |
6208 \def\normaldoublequote{"} | |
6209 \def\normaltilde{~} | |
6210 \def\normalcaret{^} | |
6211 \def\normalunderscore{_} | |
6212 \def\normalverticalbar{|} | |
6213 \def\normalless{<} | |
6214 \def\normalgreater{>} | |
6215 \def\normalplus{+} | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6216 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix |
41418 | 6217 |
6218 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont | |
6219 % where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts, | |
6220 % where something hairier probably needs to be done. | |
6221 % | |
6222 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print | |
6223 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero | |
6224 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all | |
6225 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. | |
6226 % | |
6227 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} | |
6228 | |
6229 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches | |
6230 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from | |
6231 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway | |
6232 % this is not a problem. | |
6233 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} | |
6234 | |
6235 % Turn off all special characters except @ | |
6236 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). | |
6237 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can | |
6238 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. | |
6239 | |
6240 \catcode`\"=\active | |
6241 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} | |
6242 \let"=\activedoublequote | |
6243 \catcode`\~=\active | |
6244 \def~{{\tt\char126}} | |
6245 \chardef\hat=`\^ | |
6246 \catcode`\^=\active | |
6247 \def^{{\tt \hat}} | |
6248 | |
6249 \catcode`\_=\active | |
6250 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} | |
6251 % Subroutine for the previous macro. | |
6252 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.06em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}} | |
6253 | |
6254 \catcode`\|=\active | |
6255 \def|{{\tt\char124}} | |
6256 \chardef \less=`\< | |
6257 \catcode`\<=\active | |
6258 \def<{{\tt \less}} | |
6259 \chardef \gtr=`\> | |
6260 \catcode`\>=\active | |
6261 \def>{{\tt \gtr}} | |
6262 \catcode`\+=\active | |
6263 \def+{{\tt \char 43}} | |
6264 \catcode`\$=\active | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6265 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
41418 | 6266 %\catcode 27=\active |
6267 %\def^^[{$\diamondsuit$} | |
6268 | |
6269 % Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time. | |
6270 {\catcode`\==\active | |
6271 \global\def={{\tt \char 61}}} | |
6272 | |
6273 \catcode`+=\active | |
6274 \catcode`\_=\active | |
6275 | |
6276 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file | |
6277 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. | |
6278 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. | |
6279 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. | |
6280 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} | |
6281 | |
6282 \catcode`\@=0 | |
6283 | |
6284 % \rawbackslashxx output one backslash character in current font | |
6285 \global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\ | |
6286 %{\catcode`\\=\other | |
6287 %@gdef@rawbackslashxx{\}} | |
6288 | |
6289 % \rawbackslash redefines \ as input to do \rawbackslashxx. | |
6290 {\catcode`\\=\active | |
6291 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx }} | |
6292 | |
6293 % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. | |
6294 \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}} | |
6295 | |
6296 % \catcode 17=0 % Define control-q | |
6297 \catcode`\\=\active | |
6298 | |
6299 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters | |
6300 % even after parsing them. | |
6301 @def@turnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote | |
6302 @let\=@realbackslash | |
6303 @let~=@normaltilde | |
6304 @let^=@normalcaret | |
6305 @let_=@normalunderscore | |
6306 @let|=@normalverticalbar | |
6307 @let<=@normalless | |
6308 @let>=@normalgreater | |
6309 @let+=@normalplus | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6310 @let$=@normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
41418 | 6311 |
6312 @def@normalturnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote | |
6313 @let\=@normalbackslash | |
6314 @let~=@normaltilde | |
6315 @let^=@normalcaret | |
6316 @let_=@normalunderscore | |
6317 @let|=@normalverticalbar | |
6318 @let<=@normalless | |
6319 @let>=@normalgreater | |
6320 @let+=@normalplus | |
47006
f267224443ae
Update to version 4.2
Robert J. Chassell <bob@rattlesnake.com>
parents:
41418
diff
changeset
|
6321 @let$=@normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
41418 | 6322 |
6323 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. | |
6324 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. | |
6325 @otherifyactive | |
6326 | |
6327 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. | |
6328 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing | |
6329 % a backslash. | |
6330 % | |
6331 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} | |
6332 @global@let\ = @eatinput | |
6333 | |
6334 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then | |
6335 % the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix | |
6336 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. | |
6337 % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input | |
6338 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. | |
6339 % | |
6340 @gdef@fixbackslash{% | |
6341 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi | |
6342 @catcode`+=@active | |
6343 @catcode`@_=@active | |
6344 } | |
6345 | |
6346 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. | |
6347 @escapechar = `@@ | |
6348 | |
6349 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. | |
6350 @catcode`@& = @other | |
6351 @catcode`@# = @other | |
6352 @catcode`@% = @other | |
6353 | |
6354 @c Set initial fonts. | |
6355 @textfonts | |
6356 @rm | |
6357 | |
6358 | |
6359 @c Local variables: | |
6360 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) | |
6361 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" | |
6362 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" | |
6363 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" | |
6364 @c time-stamp-end: "}" | |
6365 @c End: |